* ld/pe-dll.c (autofilter_symbollist): Add cygwin_crt0.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @set EDITION Ninth
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34 @set DATE June 2002
35
36 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
38
39 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
40
41 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
42 @c manuals to an info tree.
43 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
44 @direntry
45 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
46 @end direntry
47
48 @ifinfo
49 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
52 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
53 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
56 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
58
59 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
62 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
65
66 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69 development.''
70 @end ifinfo
71
72 @titlepage
73 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77 @subtitle @value{DATE}
78 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
79 @page
80 @tex
81 {\parskip=0pt
82 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
83 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85 }
86 @end tex
87
88 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
89 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
90 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
91 @sp 2
92 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
93 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
95 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
96
97 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
100 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
103
104 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107 development.''
108 @end titlepage
109 @page
110
111 @ifnottex
112 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
114 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
118 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
119 @value{GDBVN}.
120
121 Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
122
123 @menu
124 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131 * Stack:: Examining the stack
132 * Source:: Examining source files
133 * Data:: Examining data
134 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
135 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
136 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
137
138 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141 * Altering:: Altering execution
142 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
144 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
145 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
148 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
163 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
164 * Index:: Index
165 @end menu
166
167 @end ifnottex
168
169 @contents
170
171 @node Summary
172 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181 @itemize @bullet
182 @item
183 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185 @item
186 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188 @item
189 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191 @item
192 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194 @end itemize
195
196 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
197 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
198 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
200 @cindex Modula-2
201 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
202 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
203
204 @cindex Pascal
205 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208 syntax.
209
210 @cindex Fortran
211 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
212 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
213 underscore.
214
215 @menu
216 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218 @end menu
219
220 @node Free Software
221 @unnumberedsec Free software
222
223 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
224 General Public License
225 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234 from anyone else.
235
236 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
237
238 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240 include with the free software. Many of our most important
241 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243 when an important free software package does not come with a free
244 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245 gaps today.
246
247 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251 them from the free software world.
252
253 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257 contract to make it non-free.
258
259 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278 community.
279
280 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288 of the manual.
289
290 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294 manual to replace it.
295
296 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301 the free software community.
302
303 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
311 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
312
313 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
319 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
321
322 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323 published by other publishers, at
324 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
326 @node Contributors
327 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
335 blow-by-blow account.
336
337 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339 @quotation
340 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343 @end quotation
344
345 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347 releases:
348 Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
349 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
361 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
366
367 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
368 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
374 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
375
376 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378 support.
379 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
394 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
395
396 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
397
398 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
399 libraries.
400
401 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
402 about several machine instruction sets.
403
404 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
405 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
406 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
407 and RDI targets, respectively.
408
409 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
410 command-line editing and command history.
411
412 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
413 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
414
415 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
416 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
417 symbols.
418
419 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
420 Super-H processors.
421
422 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
423
424 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
425
426 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
427
428 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
429
430 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
431
432 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
433 watchpoints.
434
435 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
436
437 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
438
439 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
440 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
441
442 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
443 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
444 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
445 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
446 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
447 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
448 information in this manual.
449
450 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
451 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
452
453 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
454 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
455 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
456 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
457 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
458 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
459 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
460 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
461 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
462 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
463 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
464 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
465 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
466 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
467 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
468
469 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
470 Hat.
471
472 @node Sample Session
473 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
474
475 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
476 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
477 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
478
479 @iftex
480 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
481 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
482 @end iftex
483
484 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
485 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
486
487 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
488 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
489 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
490 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
491 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
492 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
493 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
494 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
495 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
496
497 @smallexample
498 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
499 $ @b{./m4}
500 @b{define(foo,0000)}
501
502 @b{foo}
503 0000
504 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
505
506 @b{bar}
507 0000
508 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
509
510 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
511 @b{baz}
512 @b{C-d}
513 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
514 @end smallexample
515
516 @noindent
517 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
518
519 @smallexample
520 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
521 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
522 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
523 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
524 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
525 the conditions.
526 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
527 for details.
528
529 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
530 (@value{GDBP})
531 @end smallexample
532
533 @noindent
534 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
535 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
536 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
537 that examples fit in this manual.
538
539 @smallexample
540 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
541 @end smallexample
542
543 @noindent
544 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
545 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
546 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
547 @code{break} command.
548
549 @smallexample
550 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
551 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
552 @end smallexample
553
554 @noindent
555 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
556 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
557 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
558
559 @smallexample
560 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
561 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
562 @b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564 @b{foo}
565 0000
566 @end smallexample
567
568 @noindent
569 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
570 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
571 context where it stops.
572
573 @smallexample
574 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
575
576 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
577 at builtin.c:879
578 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
579 @end smallexample
580
581 @noindent
582 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
583 the next line of the current function.
584
585 @smallexample
586 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
588 : nil,
589 @end smallexample
590
591 @noindent
592 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
593 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
594 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
595 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
596
597 @smallexample
598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
599 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
600 at input.c:530
601 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
606 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
607 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
608 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
609 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
610 stack frame for each active subroutine.
611
612 @smallexample
613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
614 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
616 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
617 at builtin.c:882
618 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
619 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
620 at macro.c:71
621 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
622 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
627 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
628 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
629
630 @smallexample
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
632 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
635 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
637 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
638 : xstrdup(rq);
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
641 @end smallexample
642
643 @noindent
644 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
645 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
646 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
647 (@code{print}) to see their values.
648
649 @smallexample
650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
651 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
653 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
658 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
659 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
660
661 @smallexample
662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
663 533 xfree(rquote);
664 534
665 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
666 : xstrdup (lq);
667 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
668 : xstrdup (rq);
669 537
670 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
671 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
672 540 @}
673 541
674 542 void
675 @end smallexample
676
677 @noindent
678 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
679 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
680
681 @smallexample
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 540 @}
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
687 $3 = 9
688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
689 $4 = 7
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
694 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
695 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
696 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
697 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
698 assignments.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
702 $5 = 7
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
704 $6 = 9
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
709 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
710 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
711 example that caused trouble initially:
712
713 @smallexample
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
715 Continuing.
716
717 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
718
719 baz
720 0000
721 @end smallexample
722
723 @noindent
724 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
725 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
726 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
727
728 @smallexample
729 @b{C-d}
730 Program exited normally.
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
735 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
736 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @node Invocation
743 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
744
745 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
746 The essentials are:
747 @itemize @bullet
748 @item
749 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
750 @item
751 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
752 @end itemize
753
754 @menu
755 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
756 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
757 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
758 @end menu
759
760 @node Invoking GDB
761 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
762
763 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
764 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
765
766 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
767 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
768
769 The command-line options described here are designed
770 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
771 options may effectively be unavailable.
772
773 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
774 specifying an executable program:
775
776 @smallexample
777 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
782 specified:
783
784 @smallexample
785 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
786 @end smallexample
787
788 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
789 to debug a running process:
790
791 @smallexample
792 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
797 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
798
799 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
800 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
801 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
802 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
803 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
804
805 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
806 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
807 option processing.
808 @smallexample
809 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
810 @end smallexample
811 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
812 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
813
814 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
815 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
816
817 @smallexample
818 @value{GDBP} -silent
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
823 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
824
825 @noindent
826 Type
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} -help
830 @end smallexample
831
832 @noindent
833 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
834 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
835
836 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
837 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
838 @samp{-x} option is used.
839
840
841 @menu
842 * File Options:: Choosing files
843 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
844 @end menu
845
846 @node File Options
847 @subsection Choosing files
848
849 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
850 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
851 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
852 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
853 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
854 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
855 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
856 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
857 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
858 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
859 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
860 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
861 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
862
863 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
864 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
865 argument and ignore it.
866
867 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
868 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
869 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
870 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
871 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
872
873 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
874 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
875 @c it.
876
877 @table @code
878 @item -symbols @var{file}
879 @itemx -s @var{file}
880 @cindex @code{--symbols}
881 @cindex @code{-s}
882 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
883
884 @item -exec @var{file}
885 @itemx -e @var{file}
886 @cindex @code{--exec}
887 @cindex @code{-e}
888 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
889 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
890
891 @item -se @var{file}
892 @cindex @code{--se}
893 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
894 file.
895
896 @item -core @var{file}
897 @itemx -c @var{file}
898 @cindex @code{--core}
899 @cindex @code{-c}
900 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
901
902 @item -c @var{number}
903 @item -pid @var{number}
904 @itemx -p @var{number}
905 @cindex @code{--pid}
906 @cindex @code{-p}
907 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
908 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
909 file named @var{number}.
910
911 @item -command @var{file}
912 @itemx -x @var{file}
913 @cindex @code{--command}
914 @cindex @code{-x}
915 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
916 Files,, Command files}.
917
918 @item -directory @var{directory}
919 @itemx -d @var{directory}
920 @cindex @code{--directory}
921 @cindex @code{-d}
922 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
923
924 @item -m
925 @itemx -mapped
926 @cindex @code{--mapped}
927 @cindex @code{-m}
928 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
929 supported on all systems.}@*
930 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
931 system call, you can use this option
932 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
933 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
934 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
935 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
936 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
937 the symbol table from the executable program.
938
939 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
940 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
941 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
942
943 @item -r
944 @itemx -readnow
945 @cindex @code{--readnow}
946 @cindex @code{-r}
947 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
948 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
949 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
950
951 @end table
952
953 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
954 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
955 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
956 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
957 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
958
959 @smallexample
960 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
961 @end smallexample
962
963 @node Mode Options
964 @subsection Choosing modes
965
966 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
967 batch mode or quiet mode.
968
969 @table @code
970 @item -nx
971 @itemx -n
972 @cindex @code{--nx}
973 @cindex @code{-n}
974 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
975 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
976 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
977 files}.
978
979 @item -quiet
980 @itemx -silent
981 @itemx -q
982 @cindex @code{--quiet}
983 @cindex @code{--silent}
984 @cindex @code{-q}
985 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
986 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
987
988 @item -batch
989 @cindex @code{--batch}
990 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
991 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
992 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
993 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
994 in the command files.
995
996 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
997 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
998 make this more useful, the message
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 Program exited normally.
1002 @end smallexample
1003
1004 @noindent
1005 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1006 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1007 mode.
1008
1009 @item -nowindows
1010 @itemx -nw
1011 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1012 @cindex @code{-nw}
1013 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1014 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1015 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1016
1017 @item -windows
1018 @itemx -w
1019 @cindex @code{--windows}
1020 @cindex @code{-w}
1021 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1022 used if possible.
1023
1024 @item -cd @var{directory}
1025 @cindex @code{--cd}
1026 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1027 instead of the current directory.
1028
1029 @item -fullname
1030 @itemx -f
1031 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1032 @cindex @code{-f}
1033 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1034 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1035 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1036 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1037 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1038 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1039 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1040 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1041 frame.
1042
1043 @item -epoch
1044 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1045 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1046 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1047 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1048 separate window.
1049
1050 @item -annotate @var{level}
1051 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1052 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1053 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1054 (@pxref{Annotations}).
1055 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1056 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1057 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1058 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1059 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1060
1061 @item -async
1062 @cindex @code{--async}
1063 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1064 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1065 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1066 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1067 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1068 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1069 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1070 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1071 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1072 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1073 yet.)
1074 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1075 @c should be removed.
1076
1077 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1078 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1079 @samp{-noasync} option.
1080
1081 @item -noasync
1082 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1083 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1084
1085 @item --args
1086 @cindex @code{--args}
1087 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1088 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1089 This option stops option processing.
1090
1091 @item -baud @var{bps}
1092 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1093 @cindex @code{--baud}
1094 @cindex @code{-b}
1095 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1096 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1097
1098 @item -tty @var{device}
1099 @itemx -t @var{device}
1100 @cindex @code{--tty}
1101 @cindex @code{-t}
1102 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1103 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1104
1105 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1106 @item -tui
1107 @cindex @code{--tui}
1108 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1109 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1110 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1111 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1112 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1113 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1114
1115 @c @item -xdb
1116 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1117 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1118 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1119 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1120 @c systems.
1121
1122 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1123 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1124 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1125 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1126 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1127
1128 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1129 @value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1130 (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1131 interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1132 @samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1133 are not supported.
1134
1135 @item -write
1136 @cindex @code{--write}
1137 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139 (@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141 @item -statistics
1142 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1143 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146 @item -version
1147 @cindex @code{--version}
1148 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
1151 @end table
1152
1153 @node Quitting GDB
1154 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158 @table @code
1159 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1160 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1161 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162 @itemx q
1163 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167 error code.
1168 @end table
1169
1170 @cindex interrupt
1171 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175 until a time when it is safe.
1176
1177 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1180
1181 @node Shell Commands
1182 @section Shell commands
1183
1184 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186 just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188 @table @code
1189 @kindex shell
1190 @cindex shell escape
1191 @item shell @var{command string}
1192 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1193 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1194 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1196 @end table
1197
1198 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200 @value{GDBN}:
1201
1202 @table @code
1203 @kindex make
1204 @cindex calling make
1205 @item make @var{make-args}
1206 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208 @end table
1209
1210 @node Commands
1211 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219 @menu
1220 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221 * Completion:: Command completion
1222 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223 @end menu
1224
1225 @node Command Syntax
1226 @section Command syntax
1227
1228 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1233 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1234
1235 @cindex abbreviation
1236 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244 @cindex repeating commands
1245 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1246 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1247 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1248 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250 repeat.
1251
1252 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
1262 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1263 @cindex comment
1264 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266 Files,,Command files}).
1267
1268 @cindex repeating command sequences
1269 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273 for editing.
1274
1275 @node Completion
1276 @section Command completion
1277
1278 @cindex completion
1279 @cindex word completion
1280 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288 enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1294 @smallexample
1295 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1296 @end smallexample
1297
1298 @noindent
1299 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
1302 @smallexample
1303 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1304 @end smallexample
1305
1306 @noindent
1307 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322 example:
1323
1324 @smallexample
1325 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1327 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328 make_abs_section make_function_type
1329 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1331 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1333 @end smallexample
1334
1335 @noindent
1336 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338 command.
1339
1340 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1341 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1342 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1343 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1344 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1345
1346 @cindex quotes in commands
1347 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1348 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1349 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352 @value{GDBN} commands.
1353
1354 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1355 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1365
1366 @smallexample
1367 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1368 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1370 @end smallexample
1371
1372 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375 place:
1376
1377 @smallexample
1378 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1381 @end smallexample
1382
1383 @noindent
1384 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
1388 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1389 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1390 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1391 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1392
1393
1394 @node Help
1395 @section Getting help
1396 @cindex online documentation
1397 @kindex help
1398
1399 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1400 using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1404 @item help
1405 @itemx h
1406 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409 @smallexample
1410 (@value{GDBP}) help
1411 List of classes of commands:
1412
1413 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1414 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1415 data -- Examining data
1416 files -- Specifying and examining files
1417 internals -- Maintenance commands
1418 obscure -- Obscure features
1419 running -- Running the program
1420 stack -- Examining the stack
1421 status -- Status inquiries
1422 support -- Support facilities
1423 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
1425 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1426
1427 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1428 commands in that class.
1429 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1430 documentation.
1431 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432 (@value{GDBP})
1433 @end smallexample
1434 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1435
1436 @item help @var{class}
1437 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439 help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441 @smallexample
1442 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1443 Status inquiries.
1444
1445 List of commands:
1446
1447 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1449 info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451 show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
1453
1454 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1455 documentation.
1456 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457 (@value{GDBP})
1458 @end smallexample
1459
1460 @item help @var{command}
1461 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
1464 @kindex apropos
1465 @item apropos @var{args}
1466 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470 @smallexample
1471 apropos reload
1472 @end smallexample
1473
1474 @noindent
1475 results in:
1476
1477 @smallexample
1478 @c @group
1479 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483 @c @end group
1484 @end smallexample
1485
1486 @kindex complete
1487 @item complete @var{args}
1488 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490 command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492 @smallexample
1493 complete i
1494 @end smallexample
1495
1496 @noindent results in:
1497
1498 @smallexample
1499 @group
1500 if
1501 ignore
1502 info
1503 inspect
1504 @end group
1505 @end smallexample
1506
1507 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508 @end table
1509
1510 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517 @c @group
1518 @table @code
1519 @kindex info
1520 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1521 @item info
1522 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527 @w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529 @kindex set
1530 @item set
1531 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1532 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533 @code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535 @kindex show
1536 @item show
1537 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1538 @value{GDBN} itself.
1539 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544 @kindex info set
1545 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551 @end table
1552 @c @end group
1553
1554 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557 @table @code
1558 @kindex show version
1559 @cindex version number
1560 @item show version
1561 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1562 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1567 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1568 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569 @value{GDBN}.
1570
1571 @kindex show copying
1572 @item show copying
1573 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575 @kindex show warranty
1576 @item show warranty
1577 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1578 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1579
1580 @end table
1581
1582 @node Running
1583 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586 debugging information when you compile it.
1587
1588 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591 kill a child process.
1592
1593 @menu
1594 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595 * Starting:: Starting your program
1596 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1598
1599 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1603
1604 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606 @end menu
1607
1608 @node Compilation
1609 @section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615 and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618 the compiler.
1619
1620 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628 @option{-g} alone.
1629
1630 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632 executables containing debugging information.
1633
1634 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638 in pushing your luck.
1639
1640 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1641 @cindex debugging optimized code
1642 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658 @need 2000
1659 @node Starting
1660 @section Starting your program
1661 @cindex starting
1662 @cindex running
1663
1664 @table @code
1665 @kindex run
1666 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1667 @item run
1668 @itemx r
1669 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1674
1675 @end table
1676
1677 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687 divided into four categories:
1688
1689 @table @asis
1690 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1691 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695 the arguments.
1696 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700 @item The @emph{environment.}
1701 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1707 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715 set a different device for your program.
1716 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718 @cindex pipes
1719 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722 wrong program.
1723 @end table
1724
1725 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734 your current breakpoints.
1735
1736 @node Arguments
1737 @section Your program's arguments
1738
1739 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1740 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1741 @code{run} command.
1742 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1746 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751 the program, not by the shell.
1752
1753 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
1756 @table @code
1757 @kindex set args
1758 @item set args
1759 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763 it again without arguments.
1764
1765 @kindex show args
1766 @item show args
1767 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768 @end table
1769
1770 @node Environment
1771 @section Your program's environment
1772
1773 @cindex environment (of your program)
1774 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782 @table @code
1783 @kindex path
1784 @item path @var{directory}
1785 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1786 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1788 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1792
1793 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798 @var{directory} to the search path.
1799 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802 @kindex show paths
1803 @item show paths
1804 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805 environment variable).
1806
1807 @kindex show environment
1808 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814 @kindex set environment
1815 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1816 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821 null value.
1822 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825 For example, this command:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 set env USER = foo
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1833 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834 are not actually required.)
1835
1836 @kindex unset environment
1837 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1838 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842 @end table
1843
1844 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845 the shell indicated
1846 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852 @file{.profile}.
1853
1854 @node Working Directory
1855 @section Your program's working directory
1856
1857 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1858 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866 specify files}.
1867
1868 @table @code
1869 @kindex cd
1870 @item cd @var{directory}
1871 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873 @kindex pwd
1874 @item pwd
1875 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 @node Input/Output
1879 @section Your program's input and output
1880
1881 @cindex redirection
1882 @cindex i/o
1883 @cindex terminal
1884 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1885 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1886 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888 running your program.
1889
1890 @table @code
1891 @kindex info terminal
1892 @item info terminal
1893 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894 program is using.
1895 @end table
1896
1897 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
1900 @smallexample
1901 run > outfile
1902 @end smallexample
1903
1904 @noindent
1905 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907 @kindex tty
1908 @cindex controlling terminal
1909 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
1915 @smallexample
1916 tty /dev/ttyb
1917 @end smallexample
1918
1919 @noindent
1920 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922 that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926 terminal.
1927
1928 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
1932 @node Attach
1933 @section Debugging an already-running process
1934 @kindex attach
1935 @cindex attach
1936
1937 @table @code
1938 @item attach @var{process-id}
1939 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946 executing the command.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959 Specify Files}.
1960
1961 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1963 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1967 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969 @table @code
1970 @kindex detach
1971 @item detach
1972 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978 executing the command.
1979 @end table
1980
1981 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986 messages}).
1987
1988 @node Kill Process
1989 @section Killing the child process
1990
1991 @table @code
1992 @kindex kill
1993 @item kill
1994 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995 @end table
1996
1997 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999 is running.
2000
2001 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004 outside the debugger.
2005
2006 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011 breakpoint settings).
2012
2013 @node Threads
2014 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2015
2016 @cindex threads of execution
2017 @cindex multiple threads
2018 @cindex switching threads
2019 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028 programs:
2029
2030 @itemize @bullet
2031 @item automatic notification of new threads
2032 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2034 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2035 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2037 @end itemize
2038
2039 @quotation
2040 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045 like this:
2046
2047 @smallexample
2048 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052 @end smallexample
2053 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054 @c doesn't support threads"?
2055 @end quotation
2056
2057 @cindex focus of debugging
2058 @cindex current thread
2059 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
2065 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2066 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2067 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074 LynxOS, you might see
2075
2076 @smallexample
2077 [New process 35 thread 27]
2078 @end smallexample
2079
2080 @noindent
2081 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083 further qualifier.
2084
2085 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2087 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2088 @c program?
2089 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2091 @c threads ab initio?
2092
2093 @cindex thread number
2094 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098 @table @code
2099 @kindex info threads
2100 @item info threads
2101 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104 @enumerate
2105 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110 @end enumerate
2111
2112 @noindent
2113 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114 indicates the current thread.
2115
2116 For example,
2117 @end table
2118 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126 @end smallexample
2127
2128 On HP-UX systems:
2129
2130 @cindex thread number
2131 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134 thread in your program.
2135
2136 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2138 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145 HP-UX, you see
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2149 @end smallexample
2150
2151 @noindent
2152 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2153
2154 @table @code
2155 @kindex info threads
2156 @item info threads
2157 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160 @enumerate
2161 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166 @end enumerate
2167
2168 @noindent
2169 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170 indicates the current thread.
2171
2172 For example,
2173 @end table
2174 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
2176 @smallexample
2177 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2184 @end smallexample
2185
2186 @table @code
2187 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188 @item thread @var{threadno}
2189 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195 @smallexample
2196 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2198 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2199 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200 @end smallexample
2201
2202 @noindent
2203 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2205 threads.
2206
2207 @kindex thread apply
2208 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2213 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2215 @end table
2216
2217 @cindex automatic thread selection
2218 @cindex switching threads automatically
2219 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2220 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224 thread.
2225
2226 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228 programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2232
2233 @node Processes
2234 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237 @cindex multiple processes
2238 @cindex processes, multiple
2239 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245 will cause it to terminate.
2246
2247 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2255 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2256 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2257
2258 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2261
2262 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268 @table @code
2269 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275 @table @code
2276 @item parent
2277 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2278 unimpeded. This is the default.
2279
2280 @item child
2281 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282 unimpeded.
2283
2284 @item ask
2285 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286 @end table
2287
2288 @item show follow-fork-mode
2289 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2290 @end table
2291
2292 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296 the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304 argument.
2305
2306 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2309
2310 @node Stopping
2311 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
2317 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323 explicitly request this information at any time.
2324
2325 @table @code
2326 @kindex info program
2327 @item info program
2328 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2329 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @menu
2333 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2335 * Signals:: Signals
2336 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2337 @end menu
2338
2339 @node Breakpoints
2340 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342 @cindex breakpoints
2343 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349 program.
2350
2351 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358 @cindex watchpoints
2359 @cindex memory tracing
2360 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371 Automatic display}.
2372
2373 @cindex catchpoints
2374 @cindex breakpoint on events
2375 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2376 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2377 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2381 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2382
2383 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2384 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391 enable it again.
2392
2393 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2394 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
2401 @menu
2402 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2408 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2409 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2410 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2411 @end menu
2412
2413 @node Set Breaks
2414 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
2416 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2417 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418 @c
2419 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421 @kindex break
2422 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2424 @cindex latest breakpoint
2425 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2426 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2427 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2428 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429 convenience variables.
2430
2431 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433 @table @code
2434 @item break @var{function}
2435 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2436 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2437 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2438 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2439
2440 @item break +@var{offset}
2441 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2442 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2443 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2444 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2445
2446 @item break @var{linenum}
2447 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2448 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2450 code on that line.
2451
2452 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459 functions.
2460
2461 @item break *@var{address}
2462 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464 information or source files.
2465
2466 @item break
2467 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476 inside loops.
2477
2478 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482 existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492 @kindex tbreak
2493 @item tbreak @var{args}
2494 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
2499 @kindex hbreak
2500 @item hbreak @var{args}
2501 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2503 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2505 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2515
2516 @kindex thbreak
2517 @item thbreak @var{args}
2518 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2520 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2521 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2523 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2525 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2526
2527 @kindex rbreak
2528 @cindex regular expression
2529 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2530 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2531 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2543
2544 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2545 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546 classes.
2547
2548 @kindex info breakpoints
2549 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556 @table @emph
2557 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2558 @item Type
2559 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560 @item Disposition
2561 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562 @item Enabled or Disabled
2563 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564 that are not enabled.
2565 @item Address
2566 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2567 @item What
2568 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569 line number.
2570 @end table
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575 are listed after that.
2576
2577 @noindent
2578 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2582 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2583
2584 @noindent
2585 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591 @end table
2592
2593 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2600 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2604 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2605 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2606
2607
2608 @node Set Watchpoints
2609 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611 @cindex setting watchpoints
2612 @cindex software watchpoints
2613 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2614 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616 this may happen.
2617
2618 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2619 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2620 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623 culprit.)
2624
2625 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2626 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2627 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628 program.
2629
2630 @table @code
2631 @kindex watch
2632 @item watch @var{expr}
2633 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636 @kindex rwatch
2637 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2638 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2639
2640 @kindex awatch
2641 @item awatch @var{expr}
2642 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2643 by the program.
2644
2645 @kindex info watchpoints
2646 @item info watchpoints
2647 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649 @end table
2650
2651 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2662 @end smallexample
2663
2664 @noindent
2665 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
2667 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673 will print a message like this:
2674
2675 @smallexample
2676 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677 @end smallexample
2678
2679 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695 @smallexample
2696 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697 @end smallexample
2698
2699 @noindent
2700 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2710 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2714 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2715 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
2717 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
2727 @quotation
2728 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2729 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2730 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737 the expression.
2738
2739 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2740 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2749 @end quotation
2750
2751 @node Set Catchpoints
2752 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2753 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2754 @cindex exception handlers
2755 @cindex event handling
2756
2757 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2758 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2759 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761 @table @code
2762 @kindex catch
2763 @item catch @var{event}
2764 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765 @table @code
2766 @item throw
2767 @kindex catch throw
2768 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2769
2770 @item catch
2771 @kindex catch catch
2772 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2773
2774 @item exec
2775 @kindex catch exec
2776 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778 @item fork
2779 @kindex catch fork
2780 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782 @item vfork
2783 @kindex catch vfork
2784 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786 @item load
2787 @itemx load @var{libname}
2788 @kindex catch load
2789 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792 @item unload
2793 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2794 @kindex catch unload
2795 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797 @end table
2798
2799 @item tcatch @var{event}
2800 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803 @end table
2804
2805 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
2807 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2808 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810 @itemize @bullet
2811 @item
2812 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819 disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821 @item
2822 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824 @item
2825 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826 @end itemize
2827
2828 @cindex raise exceptions
2829 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834 out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2837 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2838 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
2841 @smallexample
2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2845 @end smallexample
2846
2847 @noindent
2848 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856 raised.
2857
2858
2859 @node Delete Breaks
2860 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872 their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @kindex clear
2880 @item clear
2881 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886 @item clear @var{function}
2887 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890 @item clear @var{linenum}
2891 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894 @cindex delete breakpoints
2895 @kindex delete
2896 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2897 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2900 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902 @end table
2903
2904 @node Disabling
2905 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907 @kindex disable breakpoints
2908 @kindex enable breakpoints
2909 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921 states of enablement:
2922
2923 @itemize @bullet
2924 @item
2925 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927 @item
2928 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929 @item
2930 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2931 disabled.
2932 @item
2933 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2934 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2936 @end itemize
2937
2938 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941 @table @code
2942 @kindex disable breakpoints
2943 @kindex disable
2944 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2945 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2946 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952 @kindex enable breakpoints
2953 @kindex enable
2954 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2955 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
2958 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2959 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
2962 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2963 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965 @end table
2966
2967 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2969 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975 stepping}.)
2976
2977 @node Conditions
2978 @subsection Break conditions
2979 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2980 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2983 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2984 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001 one.
3002
3003 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3010 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011 conditions for the
3012 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018 with the @code{condition} command.
3019
3020 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023 catchpoint.
3024
3025 @table @code
3026 @kindex condition
3027 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3034 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036 prints an error message:
3037
3038 @smallexample
3039 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3040 @end smallexample
3041
3042 @noindent
3043 @value{GDBN} does
3044 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3045 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3047
3048 @item condition @var{bnum}
3049 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051 @end table
3052
3053 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063 your program reaches it.
3064
3065 @table @code
3066 @kindex ignore
3067 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071 takes no action.
3072
3073 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074 a count of zero.
3075
3076 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088 variables}.
3089 @end table
3090
3091 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
3094 @node Break Commands
3095 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097 @cindex breakpoint commands
3098 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101 enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103 @table @code
3104 @kindex commands
3105 @kindex end
3106 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108 @itemx end
3109 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118 recently encountered).
3119 @end table
3120
3121 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126 that resumes execution.
3127
3128 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134 @kindex silent
3135 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
3149 @smallexample
3150 break foo if x>0
3151 commands
3152 silent
3153 printf "x is %d\n",x
3154 cont
3155 end
3156 @end smallexample
3157
3158 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
3166 @smallexample
3167 break 403
3168 commands
3169 silent
3170 set x = y + 4
3171 cont
3172 end
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @node Breakpoint Menus
3176 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3177 @cindex overloading
3178 @cindex symbol overloading
3179
3180 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3181 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192 breakpoints.
3193
3194 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199 @smallexample
3200 @group
3201 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202 [0] cancel
3203 [1] all
3204 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210 > 2 4 6
3211 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217 (@value{GDBP})
3218 @end group
3219 @end smallexample
3220
3221 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3222 @node Error in Breakpoints
3223 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3224 @c
3225 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226 @c
3227 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3229 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3230 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
3232 @smallexample
3233 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234 The same program may be running in another process.
3235 @end smallexample
3236
3237 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239 @enumerate
3240 @item
3241 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243 @item
3244 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3245 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3246 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3247 Then start your program again.
3248
3249 @item
3250 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252 to nonsharable executables.
3253 @end enumerate
3254 @c @end ifclear
3255
3256 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261 @smallexample
3262 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264 @end smallexample
3265
3266 @noindent
3267 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
3275 @node Continuing and Stepping
3276 @section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278 @cindex stepping
3279 @cindex continuing
3280 @cindex resuming execution
3281 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3285 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3287 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex continue
3292 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3294 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305 @code{continue} is ignored.
3306
3307 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310 @code{continue}.
3311 @end table
3312
3313 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325 @table @code
3326 @kindex step
3327 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3328 @item step
3329 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331 abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333 @quotation
3334 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337 @c distinction here.
3338 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344 below.
3345 @end quotation
3346
3347 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352 called within the line.
3353
3354 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3356 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3357 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3358 was any debugging information about the routine.
3359
3360 @item step @var{count}
3361 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3362 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3364
3365 @kindex next
3366 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3367 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3369 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3374
3375 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380 @c
3381 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383 @c function are executed without stopping.
3384
3385 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3387 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3388
3389 @kindex set step-mode
3390 @item set step-mode
3391 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393 @itemx set step-mode on
3394 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3395 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396 information rather than stepping over it.
3397
3398 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3401
3402 @item set step-mode off
3403 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3404 debug information. This is the default.
3405
3406 @kindex finish
3407 @item finish
3408 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412 ,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414 @kindex until
3415 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3416 @item until
3417 @itemx u
3418 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423 than the address of the jump.
3424
3425 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429 through the next iteration.
3430
3431 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432 stack frame.
3433
3434 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
3440 @smallexample
3441 (@value{GDBP}) f
3442 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443 206 expand_input();
3444 (@value{GDBP}) until
3445 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3446 @end smallexample
3447
3448 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458 argument.
3459
3460 @item until @var{location}
3461 @itemx u @var{location}
3462 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468 @kindex stepi
3469 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3470 @item stepi
3471 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3472 @itemx si
3473 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478 Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482 @need 750
3483 @kindex nexti
3484 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3485 @item nexti
3486 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3487 @itemx ni
3488 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489 proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492 @end table
3493
3494 @node Signals
3495 @section Signals
3496 @cindex signals
3497
3498 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3501 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3502 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505 requested an alarm).
3506
3507 @cindex fatal signals
3508 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3510 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3511 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517 signal.
3518
3519 @cindex handling signals
3520 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3523 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526 @table @code
3527 @kindex info signals
3528 @item info signals
3529 @itemx info handle
3530 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532 the defined types of signals.
3533
3534 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3535
3536 @kindex handle
3537 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3538 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3540 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3541 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3543 @end table
3544
3545 @c @group
3546 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547 Their full names are:
3548
3549 @table @code
3550 @item nostop
3551 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554 @item stop
3555 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558 @item print
3559 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561 @item noprint
3562 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565 @item pass
3566 @itemx noignore
3567 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3569 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3570
3571 @item nopass
3572 @itemx ignore
3573 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3574 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3575 @end table
3576 @c @end group
3577
3578 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579 program until you
3580 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584 program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
3586 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589 erroneous signals.
3590
3591 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3599 program a signal}.
3600
3601 @node Thread Stops
3602 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608 @table @code
3609 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3610 @cindex thread breakpoints
3611 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625 program.
3626
3627 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629 breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631 @smallexample
3632 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 @end table
3636
3637 @cindex stopped threads
3638 @cindex threads, stopped
3639 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643 underfoot.
3644
3645 @cindex continuing threads
3646 @cindex threads, continuing
3647 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3649 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3650
3651 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657 stops.
3658
3659 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665 thread to run.
3666
3667 @table @code
3668 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3675 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3676 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3677 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3678 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3679 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3680
3681 @item show scheduler-locking
3682 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683 @end table
3684
3685
3686 @node Stack
3687 @chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690 stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692 @cindex call stack
3693 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694 is generated.
3695 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696 the arguments of the call,
3697 and the local variables of the function being called.
3698 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3699 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700 stack}.
3701
3702 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705 @cindex selected frame
3706 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3714 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3715 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717 @menu
3718 * Frames:: Stack frames
3719 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3722
3723 @end menu
3724
3725 @node Frames
3726 @section Stack frames
3727
3728 @cindex frame, definition
3729 @cindex stack frame
3730 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734 which the function is executing.
3735
3736 @cindex initial frame
3737 @cindex outermost frame
3738 @cindex innermost frame
3739 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748 @cindex frame pointer
3749 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754 going on in that frame.
3755
3756 @cindex frame number
3757 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
3763 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764 @c underflow problems.
3765 @cindex frameless execution
3766 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3767 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3768 @smallexample
3769 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3770 @end smallexample
3771 generates functions without a frame.)
3772 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780 @table @code
3781 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3782 @cindex current stack frame
3783 @item frame @var{args}
3784 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3785 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3786 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3788
3789 @kindex select-frame
3790 @cindex selecting frame silently
3791 @item select-frame
3792 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794 @code{frame}.
3795 @end table
3796
3797 @node Backtrace
3798 @section Backtraces
3799
3800 @cindex backtraces
3801 @cindex tracebacks
3802 @cindex stack traces
3803 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806 stack.
3807
3808 @table @code
3809 @kindex backtrace
3810 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3811 @item backtrace
3812 @itemx bt
3813 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814 frames in the stack.
3815
3816 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819 @item backtrace @var{n}
3820 @itemx bt @var{n}
3821 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3824 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3825 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826 @end table
3827
3828 @kindex where
3829 @kindex info stack
3830 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3831 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839 line number.
3840
3841 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844 @smallexample
3845 @group
3846 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851 (More stack frames follow...)
3852 @end group
3853 @end smallexample
3854
3855 @noindent
3856 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
3860 Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3861 and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3862 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3863 the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3864 uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3865 change this behavior.
3866
3867 @table @code
3868 @item set backtrace-below-main off
3869 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3870 default.
3871
3872 @item set backtrace-below-main
3873 @itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3874 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3875
3876 @item show backtrace-below-main
3877 Display the current backtrace policy.
3878 @end table
3879
3880 @node Selection
3881 @section Selecting a frame
3882
3883 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3884 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3885 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3886 of the stack frame just selected.
3887
3888 @table @code
3889 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3890 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3891 @item frame @var{n}
3892 @itemx f @var{n}
3893 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3894 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3895 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3896 @code{main}.
3897
3898 @item frame @var{addr}
3899 @itemx f @var{addr}
3900 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3901 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3902 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3903 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3904 switches between them.
3905
3906 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3907 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3908
3909 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3910 pointer and a program counter.
3911
3912 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3913 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3914 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3915 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3916 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3917
3918 @kindex up
3919 @item up @var{n}
3920 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3921 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3922 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3923
3924 @kindex down
3925 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3926 @item down @var{n}
3927 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3928 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3929 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3930 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3931 @end table
3932
3933 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3934 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3935 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3936 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3937
3938 @need 1000
3939 For example:
3940
3941 @smallexample
3942 @group
3943 (@value{GDBP}) up
3944 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3945 at env.c:10
3946 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3947 @end group
3948 @end smallexample
3949
3950 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3951 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3952 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3953 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3954 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3955 for details.
3956
3957 @table @code
3958 @kindex down-silently
3959 @kindex up-silently
3960 @item up-silently @var{n}
3961 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3962 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3963 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3964 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3965 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3966 distracting.
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @node Frame Info
3970 @section Information about a frame
3971
3972 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3973 stack frame.
3974
3975 @table @code
3976 @item frame
3977 @itemx f
3978 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3979 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3980 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3981 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3982 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3983
3984 @kindex info frame
3985 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3986 @item info frame
3987 @itemx info f
3988 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3989 including:
3990
3991 @itemize @bullet
3992 @item
3993 the address of the frame
3994 @item
3995 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3996 @item
3997 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3998 @item
3999 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4000 @item
4001 the address of the frame's arguments
4002 @item
4003 the address of the frame's local variables
4004 @item
4005 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4006 @item
4007 which registers were saved in the frame
4008 @end itemize
4009
4010 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4011 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4012 the usual conventions.
4013
4014 @item info frame @var{addr}
4015 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4016 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4017 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4018 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4019 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4020 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4021
4022 @kindex info args
4023 @item info args
4024 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4025
4026 @item info locals
4027 @kindex info locals
4028 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4029 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4030 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4031
4032 @kindex info catch
4033 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4034 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4035 @item info catch
4036 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4037 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4038 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4039 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4040 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4041
4042 @end table
4043
4044
4045 @node Source
4046 @chapter Examining Source Files
4047
4048 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4049 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4050 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4051 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4052 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4053 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4054 source files by explicit command.
4055
4056 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4057 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4058 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4059
4060 @menu
4061 * List:: Printing source lines
4062 * Edit:: Editing source files
4063 * Search:: Searching source files
4064 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4065 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4066 @end menu
4067
4068 @node List
4069 @section Printing source lines
4070
4071 @kindex list
4072 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4073 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4074 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4075 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4076
4077 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4078
4079 @table @code
4080 @item list @var{linenum}
4081 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4082 current source file.
4083
4084 @item list @var{function}
4085 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4086 @var{function}.
4087
4088 @item list
4089 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4090 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4091 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4092 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4093 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4094
4095 @item list -
4096 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4097 @end table
4098
4099 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4100 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4101
4102 @table @code
4103 @kindex set listsize
4104 @item set listsize @var{count}
4105 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4106 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4107
4108 @kindex show listsize
4109 @item show listsize
4110 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4111 @end table
4112
4113 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4114 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4115 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4116 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4117 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4118
4119 @cindex linespec
4120 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4121 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4122 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4123 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4124
4125 @table @code
4126 @item list @var{linespec}
4127 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4128
4129 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4130 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4131 linespecs.
4132
4133 @item list ,@var{last}
4134 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4135
4136 @item list @var{first},
4137 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4138
4139 @item list +
4140 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4141
4142 @item list -
4143 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4144
4145 @item list
4146 As described in the preceding table.
4147 @end table
4148
4149 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4150 kinds of linespec.
4151
4152 @table @code
4153 @item @var{number}
4154 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4155 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4156 the same source file as the first linespec.
4157
4158 @item +@var{offset}
4159 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4160 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4161 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4162 first linespec.
4163
4164 @item -@var{offset}
4165 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4166
4167 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4168 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4169
4170 @item @var{function}
4171 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4172 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4173
4174 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4175 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4176 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4177 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4178 identically named functions in different source files.
4179
4180 @item *@var{address}
4181 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4182 @var{address} may be any expression.
4183 @end table
4184
4185 @node Edit
4186 @section Editing source files
4187 @cindex editing source files
4188
4189 @kindex edit
4190 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4191 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4192 The editing program of your choice
4193 is invoked with the current line set to
4194 the active line in the program.
4195 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4196 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4197
4198 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4199
4200 @table @code
4201 @item edit
4202 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4203
4204 @item edit @var{number}
4205 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4206
4207 @item edit @var{function}
4208 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4209
4210 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4211 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4212
4213 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4214 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4215 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4216 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4217 identically named functions in different source files.
4218
4219 @item edit *@var{address}
4220 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4221 @var{address} may be any expression.
4222 @end table
4223
4224 @subsection Choosing your editor
4225 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4226 @footnote{
4227 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4228 following command-line syntax:
4229 @smallexample
4230 ex +@var{number} file
4231 @end smallexample
4232 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4233 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4234 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4235 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4236 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4237 @smallexample
4238 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4239 export EDITOR
4240 gdb ...
4241 @end smallexample
4242 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4243 @smallexample
4244 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4245 gdb ...
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 @node Search
4249 @section Searching source files
4250 @cindex searching
4251 @kindex reverse-search
4252
4253 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4254 regular expression.
4255
4256 @table @code
4257 @kindex search
4258 @kindex forward-search
4259 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4260 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4261 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4262 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4263 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4264 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4265 @code{fo}.
4266
4267 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4268 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4269 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4270 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4271 this command as @code{rev}.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 @node Source Path
4275 @section Specifying source directories
4276
4277 @cindex source path
4278 @cindex directories for source files
4279 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4280 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4281 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4282 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4283 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4284 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4285 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4286 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4287 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4288 path.
4289
4290 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4291 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4292 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4293 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4294 last resort.
4295
4296 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4297 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4298 each line is in the file.
4299
4300 @kindex directory
4301 @kindex dir
4302 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4303 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4304 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4305
4306 @table @code
4307 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4308 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4309 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4310 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4311 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4312 part of absolute file names) or
4313 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4314 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4315
4316 @kindex cdir
4317 @kindex cwd
4318 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4319 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4320 @cindex compilation directory
4321 @cindex current directory
4322 @cindex working directory
4323 @cindex directory, current
4324 @cindex directory, compilation
4325 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4326 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4327 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4328 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4329 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4330 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4331
4332 @item directory
4333 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4334
4335 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4336 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4337
4338 @item show directories
4339 @kindex show directories
4340 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4341 @end table
4342
4343 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4344 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4345 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4346
4347 @enumerate
4348 @item
4349 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4350
4351 @item
4352 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4353 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4354 directories in one command.
4355 @end enumerate
4356
4357 @node Machine Code
4358 @section Source and machine code
4359
4360 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4361 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4362 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4363 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4364 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4365 well as hex.
4366
4367 @table @code
4368 @kindex info line
4369 @item info line @var{linespec}
4370 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4371 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4372 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4373 source lines}).
4374 @end table
4375
4376 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4377 the object code for the first line of function
4378 @code{m4_changequote}:
4379
4380 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4381 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4382 @smallexample
4383 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4384 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4385 @end smallexample
4386
4387 @noindent
4388 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4389 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4390 @smallexample
4391 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4392 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4393 @end smallexample
4394
4395 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4396 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4397 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4398 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4399 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4400 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4401 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4402 variables}).
4403
4404 @table @code
4405 @kindex disassemble
4406 @cindex assembly instructions
4407 @cindex instructions, assembly
4408 @cindex machine instructions
4409 @cindex listing machine instructions
4410 @item disassemble
4411 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4412 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4413 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4414 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4415 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4416 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4417 @end table
4418
4419 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4420 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4421
4422 @smallexample
4423 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4424 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4425 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4426 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4427 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4428 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4429 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4430 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4431 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4432 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4433 End of assembler dump.
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4437 mnemonics or other syntax.
4438
4439 @table @code
4440 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4441 @cindex assembly instructions
4442 @cindex instructions, assembly
4443 @cindex machine instructions
4444 @cindex listing machine instructions
4445 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4446 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4447 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4448 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4449 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4450
4451 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4452 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4453 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4454 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4455 @end table
4456
4457
4458 @node Data
4459 @chapter Examining Data
4460
4461 @cindex printing data
4462 @cindex examining data
4463 @kindex print
4464 @kindex inspect
4465 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4466 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4467 @c different window or something like that.
4468 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4469 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4470 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4471 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4472 Different Languages}).
4473
4474 @table @code
4475 @item print @var{expr}
4476 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4477 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4478 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4479 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4480 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4481 formats}.
4482
4483 @item print
4484 @itemx print /@var{f}
4485 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4486 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4487 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4488 @end table
4489
4490 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4491 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4492 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4493
4494 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4495 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4496 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4497 Table}.
4498
4499 @menu
4500 * Expressions:: Expressions
4501 * Variables:: Program variables
4502 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4503 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4504 * Memory:: Examining memory
4505 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4506 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4507 * Value History:: Value history
4508 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4509 * Registers:: Registers
4510 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4511 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4512 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4513 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4514 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4515 character set than GDB does
4516 @end menu
4517
4518 @node Expressions
4519 @section Expressions
4520
4521 @cindex expressions
4522 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4523 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4524 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4525 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4526 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4527 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4528 @ref{Compilation}.
4529
4530 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4531 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4532 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4533 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4534
4535 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4536 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4537 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4538 languages.
4539
4540 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4541 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4542
4543 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4544 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4545 at that address in memory.
4546 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4547
4548 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4549 to programming languages:
4550
4551 @table @code
4552 @item @@
4553 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4554 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4555
4556 @item ::
4557 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4558 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4559
4560 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4561 @cindex type casting memory
4562 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4563 @cindex casts, to view memory
4564 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4565 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4566 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4567 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4568 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4569 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4570 @end table
4571
4572 @node Variables
4573 @section Program variables
4574
4575 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4576 in your program.
4577
4578 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4579 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4580
4581 @itemize @bullet
4582 @item
4583 global (or file-static)
4584 @end itemize
4585
4586 @noindent or
4587
4588 @itemize @bullet
4589 @item
4590 visible according to the scope rules of the
4591 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4592 @end itemize
4593
4594 @noindent This means that in the function
4595
4596 @smallexample
4597 foo (a)
4598 int a;
4599 @{
4600 bar (a);
4601 @{
4602 int b = test ();
4603 bar (b);
4604 @}
4605 @}
4606 @end smallexample
4607
4608 @noindent
4609 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4610 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4611 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4612 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4613
4614 @cindex variable name conflict
4615 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4616 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4617 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4618 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4619 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4620 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4621 using the colon-colon notation:
4622
4623 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4624 @iftex
4625 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4626 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4627 @end iftex
4628 @smallexample
4629 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4630 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4631 @end smallexample
4632
4633 @noindent
4634 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4635 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4636 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4637 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4638
4639 @smallexample
4640 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4641 @end smallexample
4642
4643 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4644 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4645 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4646 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4647 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4648 @c conflict?? --mew
4649
4650 @cindex wrong values
4651 @cindex variable values, wrong
4652 @quotation
4653 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4654 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4655 scope, and just before exit.
4656 @end quotation
4657 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4658 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4659 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4660 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4661 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4662 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4663 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4664 variable definitions may be gone.
4665
4666 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4667 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4668 when compiling.
4669
4670 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4671 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4672 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4673 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4674 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4675 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4676 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4677
4678 @smallexample
4679 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4683 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4684 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
4685 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4686 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4687 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4688 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4689 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4690 information.
4691
4692
4693 @node Arrays
4694 @section Artificial arrays
4695
4696 @cindex artificial array
4697 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4698 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4699 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4700 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4701 program.
4702
4703 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4704 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4705 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4706 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4707 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4708 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4709 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4710 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4711 example. If a program says
4712
4713 @smallexample
4714 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4715 @end smallexample
4716
4717 @noindent
4718 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4719
4720 @smallexample
4721 p *array@@len
4722 @end smallexample
4723
4724 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4725 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4726 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4727 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4728 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4729
4730 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4731 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4732 The value need not be in memory:
4733 @smallexample
4734 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4735 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4736 @end smallexample
4737
4738 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4739 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4740 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4741 @smallexample
4742 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4743 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4744 @end smallexample
4745
4746 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4747 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4748 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4749 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4750 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4751 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4752 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4753 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4754 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4755 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4756
4757 @smallexample
4758 set $i = 0
4759 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4760 @key{RET}
4761 @key{RET}
4762 @dots{}
4763 @end smallexample
4764
4765 @node Output Formats
4766 @section Output formats
4767
4768 @cindex formatted output
4769 @cindex output formats
4770 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4771 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4772 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4773 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4774 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4775
4776 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4777 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4778 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4779 letters supported are:
4780
4781 @table @code
4782 @item x
4783 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4784 hexadecimal.
4785
4786 @item d
4787 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4788
4789 @item u
4790 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4791
4792 @item o
4793 Print as integer in octal.
4794
4795 @item t
4796 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4797 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4798 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4799 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4800
4801 @item a
4802 @cindex unknown address, locating
4803 @cindex locate address
4804 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4805 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4806 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4810 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4811 @end smallexample
4812
4813 @noindent
4814 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4815 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4816
4817 @item c
4818 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4819
4820 @item f
4821 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4822 using typical floating point syntax.
4823 @end table
4824
4825 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4826
4827 @smallexample
4828 p/x $pc
4829 @end smallexample
4830
4831 @noindent
4832 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4833 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4834
4835 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4836 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4837 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4838
4839 @node Memory
4840 @section Examining memory
4841
4842 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4843 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4844
4845 @cindex examining memory
4846 @table @code
4847 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4848 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4849 @itemx x @var{addr}
4850 @itemx x
4851 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4852 @end table
4853
4854 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4855 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4856 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4857 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4858 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4859
4860 @table @r
4861 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4862 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4863 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4864 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4865 @c 4.1.2.
4866
4867 @item @var{f}, the display format
4868 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4869 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4870 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4871 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4872
4873 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4874 The unit size is any of
4875
4876 @table @code
4877 @item b
4878 Bytes.
4879 @item h
4880 Halfwords (two bytes).
4881 @item w
4882 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4883 @item g
4884 Giant words (eight bytes).
4885 @end table
4886
4887 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4888 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4889 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4890
4891 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4892 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4893 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4894 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4895 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4896 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4897 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4898 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4899 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4900 a value from memory).
4901 @end table
4902
4903 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4904 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4905 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4906 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4907 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4908
4909 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4910 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4911 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4912 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4913 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4914
4915 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4916 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4917 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4918 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4919 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4920 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4921
4922 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4923 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4924 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4925 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4926 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4927 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4928 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4929
4930 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4931 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4932 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4933 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4934 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4935 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4936 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4937 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4938 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4939
4940 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4941 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4942 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4943
4944 @node Auto Display
4945 @section Automatic display
4946 @cindex automatic display
4947 @cindex display of expressions
4948
4949 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4950 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4951 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4952 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4953 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4954 The automatic display looks like this:
4955
4956 @smallexample
4957 2: foo = 38
4958 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4959 @end smallexample
4960
4961 @noindent
4962 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4963 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4964 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4965 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4966 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4967 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4968 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4969
4970 @table @code
4971 @kindex display
4972 @item display @var{expr}
4973 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4974 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4975
4976 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4977
4978 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4979 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4980 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4981 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4982 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4983
4984 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4985 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4986 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4987 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4988 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4989 @end table
4990
4991 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4992 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4993 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4994
4995 @table @code
4996 @kindex delete display
4997 @kindex undisplay
4998 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4999 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5000 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5001
5002 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5003 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5004
5005 @kindex disable display
5006 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5007 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5008 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5009 enabled again later.
5010
5011 @kindex enable display
5012 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5013 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5014 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5015
5016 @item display
5017 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5018 done when your program stops.
5019
5020 @kindex info display
5021 @item info display
5022 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5023 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5024 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5025 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5026 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5027 @end table
5028
5029 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5030 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5031 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5032 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5033 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5034 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5035 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5036 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5037 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5038 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5039
5040 @node Print Settings
5041 @section Print settings
5042
5043 @cindex format options
5044 @cindex print settings
5045 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5046 and symbols are printed.
5047
5048 @noindent
5049 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5050
5051 @table @code
5052 @kindex set print address
5053 @item set print address
5054 @itemx set print address on
5055 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5056 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5057 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5058 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5059 @code{set print address on}:
5060
5061 @smallexample
5062 @group
5063 (@value{GDBP}) f
5064 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5065 at input.c:530
5066 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5067 @end group
5068 @end smallexample
5069
5070 @item set print address off
5071 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5072 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5073
5074 @smallexample
5075 @group
5076 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5077 (@value{GDBP}) f
5078 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5079 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5080 @end group
5081 @end smallexample
5082
5083 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5084 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5085 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5086 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5087
5088 @kindex show print address
5089 @item show print address
5090 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5091 @end table
5092
5093 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5094 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5095 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5096 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5097 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5098 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5099 it prints a symbolic address:
5100
5101 @table @code
5102 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5103 @item set print symbol-filename on
5104 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5105 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5106
5107 @item set print symbol-filename off
5108 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5109 default.
5110
5111 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5112 @item show print symbol-filename
5113 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5114 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5115 @end table
5116
5117 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5118 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5119 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5120
5121 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5122 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5123
5124 @table @code
5125 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5126 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5127 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5128 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5129 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5130 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5131
5132 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5133 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5134 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5135 symbolic address.
5136 @end table
5137
5138 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5139 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5140 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5141 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5142 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5143 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5144 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5145 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5146
5147 @smallexample
5148 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5149 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5150 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5151 @end smallexample
5152
5153 @quotation
5154 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5155 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5156 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5157 @end quotation
5158
5159 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @kindex set print array
5163 @item set print array
5164 @itemx set print array on
5165 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5166 but uses more space. The default is off.
5167
5168 @item set print array off
5169 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5170
5171 @kindex show print array
5172 @item show print array
5173 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5174 arrays.
5175
5176 @kindex set print elements
5177 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5178 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5179 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5180 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5181 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5182 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5183 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5184
5185 @kindex show print elements
5186 @item show print elements
5187 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5188 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5189
5190 @kindex set print null-stop
5191 @item set print null-stop
5192 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5193 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5194 contain only short strings.
5195 The default is off.
5196
5197 @kindex set print pretty
5198 @item set print pretty on
5199 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5200 per line, like this:
5201
5202 @smallexample
5203 @group
5204 $1 = @{
5205 next = 0x0,
5206 flags = @{
5207 sweet = 1,
5208 sour = 1
5209 @},
5210 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5211 @}
5212 @end group
5213 @end smallexample
5214
5215 @item set print pretty off
5216 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5217
5218 @smallexample
5219 @group
5220 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5221 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5222 @end group
5223 @end smallexample
5224
5225 @noindent
5226 This is the default format.
5227
5228 @kindex show print pretty
5229 @item show print pretty
5230 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5231
5232 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5233 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5234 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5235 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5236 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5237 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5238 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5239
5240 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5241 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5242 international character sets, and is the default.
5243
5244 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5245 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5246 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5247
5248 @kindex set print union
5249 @item set print union on
5250 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5251 is the default setting.
5252
5253 @item set print union off
5254 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5255
5256 @kindex show print union
5257 @item show print union
5258 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5259 structures.
5260
5261 For example, given the declarations
5262
5263 @smallexample
5264 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5265 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5266 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5267 Bug_forms;
5268
5269 struct thing @{
5270 Species it;
5271 union @{
5272 Tree_forms tree;
5273 Bug_forms bug;
5274 @} form;
5275 @};
5276
5277 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5278 @end smallexample
5279
5280 @noindent
5281 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5282
5283 @smallexample
5284 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5285 @end smallexample
5286
5287 @noindent
5288 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5289
5290 @smallexample
5291 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5292 @end smallexample
5293 @end table
5294
5295 @need 1000
5296 @noindent
5297 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5298
5299 @table @code
5300 @cindex demangling
5301 @kindex set print demangle
5302 @item set print demangle
5303 @itemx set print demangle on
5304 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5305 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5306 linkage. The default is on.
5307
5308 @kindex show print demangle
5309 @item show print demangle
5310 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5311
5312 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5313 @item set print asm-demangle
5314 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5315 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5316 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5317 The default is off.
5318
5319 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5320 @item show print asm-demangle
5321 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5322 or demangled form.
5323
5324 @kindex set demangle-style
5325 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5326 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5327 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5328 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5329 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5330
5331 @table @code
5332 @item auto
5333 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5334
5335 @item gnu
5336 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5337 This is the default.
5338
5339 @item hp
5340 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5341
5342 @item lucid
5343 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5344
5345 @item arm
5346 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5347 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5348 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5349 require further enhancement to permit that.
5350
5351 @end table
5352 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5353
5354 @kindex show demangle-style
5355 @item show demangle-style
5356 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5357
5358 @kindex set print object
5359 @item set print object
5360 @itemx set print object on
5361 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5362 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5363 the virtual function table.
5364
5365 @item set print object off
5366 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5367 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5368
5369 @kindex show print object
5370 @item show print object
5371 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5372
5373 @kindex set print static-members
5374 @item set print static-members
5375 @itemx set print static-members on
5376 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5377
5378 @item set print static-members off
5379 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5380
5381 @kindex show print static-members
5382 @item show print static-members
5383 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5384
5385 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5386 @kindex set print vtbl
5387 @item set print vtbl
5388 @itemx set print vtbl on
5389 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5390 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5391 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5392
5393 @item set print vtbl off
5394 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5395
5396 @kindex show print vtbl
5397 @item show print vtbl
5398 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5399 @end table
5400
5401 @node Value History
5402 @section Value history
5403
5404 @cindex value history
5405 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5406 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5407 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5408 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5409 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5410 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5411 symbol table.
5412
5413 @cindex @code{$}
5414 @cindex @code{$$}
5415 @cindex history number
5416 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5417 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5418 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5419 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5420 history number.
5421
5422 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5423 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5424 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5425 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5426 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5427 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5428 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5429
5430 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5431 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5432
5433 @smallexample
5434 p *$
5435 @end smallexample
5436
5437 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5438 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5439
5440 @smallexample
5441 p *$.next
5442 @end smallexample
5443
5444 @noindent
5445 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5446 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5447
5448 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5449 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5450
5451 @smallexample
5452 print x
5453 set x=5
5454 @end smallexample
5455
5456 @noindent
5457 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5458 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5459
5460 @table @code
5461 @kindex show values
5462 @item show values
5463 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5464 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5465 values} does not change the history.
5466
5467 @item show values @var{n}
5468 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5469
5470 @item show values +
5471 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5472 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5473 @end table
5474
5475 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5476 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5477
5478 @node Convenience Vars
5479 @section Convenience variables
5480
5481 @cindex convenience variables
5482 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5483 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5484 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5485 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5486 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5487
5488 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5489 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5490 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5491 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5492 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5493
5494 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5495 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5496 For example:
5497
5498 @smallexample
5499 set $foo = *object_ptr
5500 @end smallexample
5501
5502 @noindent
5503 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5504 @code{object_ptr}.
5505
5506 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5507 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5508 value with another assignment at any time.
5509
5510 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5511 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5512 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5513 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5514
5515 @table @code
5516 @kindex show convenience
5517 @item show convenience
5518 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5519 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5520 @end table
5521
5522 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5523 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5524 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5525
5526 @smallexample
5527 set $i = 0
5528 print bar[$i++]->contents
5529 @end smallexample
5530
5531 @noindent
5532 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5533
5534 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5535 values likely to be useful.
5536
5537 @table @code
5538 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5539 @item $_
5540 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5541 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5542 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5543 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5544 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5545 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5546 to the type of @code{$__}.
5547
5548 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5549 @item $__
5550 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5551 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5552 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5553
5554 @item $_exitcode
5555 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5556 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5557 the program being debugged terminates.
5558 @end table
5559
5560 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5561 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5562 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5563
5564 @node Registers
5565 @section Registers
5566
5567 @cindex registers
5568 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5569 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5570 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5571 your machine.
5572
5573 @table @code
5574 @kindex info registers
5575 @item info registers
5576 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5577 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5578
5579 @kindex info all-registers
5580 @cindex floating point registers
5581 @item info all-registers
5582 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5583 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5584
5585 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5586 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5587 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5588 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5589 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5590 @end table
5591
5592 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5593 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5594 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5595 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5596 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5597 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5598 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5599 you could print the program counter in hex with
5600
5601 @smallexample
5602 p/x $pc
5603 @end smallexample
5604
5605 @noindent
5606 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5607
5608 @smallexample
5609 x/i $pc
5610 @end smallexample
5611
5612 @noindent
5613 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5614 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5615 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5616 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5617 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5618 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5619 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5620
5621 @smallexample
5622 set $sp += 4
5623 @end smallexample
5624
5625 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5626 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5627 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5628 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5629 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5630 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5631 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5632
5633 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5634 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5635 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5636 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5637 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5638 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5639 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5640
5641 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5642 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5643 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5644 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5645 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5646 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5647 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5648 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5649 prints the data in both formats.
5650
5651 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5652 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5653 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5654 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5655 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5656 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5657
5658 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5659 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5660 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5661 frame makes no difference.
5662
5663 @node Floating Point Hardware
5664 @section Floating point hardware
5665 @cindex floating point
5666
5667 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5668 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5669
5670 @table @code
5671 @kindex info float
5672 @item info float
5673 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5674 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5675 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5676 the ARM and x86 machines.
5677 @end table
5678
5679 @node Vector Unit
5680 @section Vector Unit
5681 @cindex vector unit
5682
5683 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5684 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5685
5686 @table @code
5687 @kindex info vector
5688 @item info vector
5689 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5690 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5691 @end table
5692
5693 @node Memory Region Attributes
5694 @section Memory region attributes
5695 @cindex memory region attributes
5696
5697 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5698 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5699 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5700 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5701
5702 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5703 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5704 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5705 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5706 all memory.
5707
5708 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5709 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex mem
5713 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5714 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5715 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5716 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5717 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5718
5719 @kindex delete mem
5720 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5721 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5722
5723 @kindex disable mem
5724 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5725 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5726 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5727 It may be enabled again later.
5728
5729 @kindex enable mem
5730 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5731 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5732
5733 @kindex info mem
5734 @item info mem
5735 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5736 for each region.
5737
5738 @table @emph
5739 @item Memory Region Number
5740 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5741 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5742 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5743
5744 @item Lo Address
5745 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5746
5747 @item Hi Address
5748 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5749
5750 @item Attributes
5751 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5752 @end table
5753 @end table
5754
5755
5756 @subsection Attributes
5757
5758 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5759 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5760 write accesses to a memory region.
5761
5762 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5763 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5764 etc. from accessing memory.
5765
5766 @table @code
5767 @item ro
5768 Memory is read only.
5769 @item wo
5770 Memory is write only.
5771 @item rw
5772 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5773 @end table
5774
5775 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5776 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5777 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5778 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5779 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5780
5781 @table @code
5782 @item 8
5783 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5784 @item 16
5785 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5786 @item 32
5787 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5788 @item 64
5789 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5790 @end table
5791
5792 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5793 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5794 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5795 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5796 @c
5797 @c @table @code
5798 @c @item hwbreak
5799 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5800 @c @item swbreak (default)
5801 @c @end table
5802
5803 @subsubsection Data Cache
5804 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5805 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5806 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5807 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5808 registers.
5809
5810 @table @code
5811 @item cache
5812 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5813 @item nocache
5814 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5815 @end table
5816
5817 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5818 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5819 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5820 @c
5821 @c @table @code
5822 @c @item verify
5823 @c @item noverify (default)
5824 @c @end table
5825
5826 @node Dump/Restore Files
5827 @section Copy between memory and a file
5828 @cindex dump/restore files
5829 @cindex append data to a file
5830 @cindex dump data to a file
5831 @cindex restore data from a file
5832 @kindex dump
5833 @kindex append
5834 @kindex restore
5835
5836 The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5837 for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5838 into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5839 file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5840 intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5841
5842 @table @code
5843 @kindex dump binary
5844 @kindex append binary
5845 @item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5846 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5847 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5848
5849 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5850 Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5851 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5852
5853 @item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5854 Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5855
5856 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5857 Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5858
5859 @kindex dump ihex
5860 @item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5861 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5862 intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5863
5864 @item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5865 Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5866
5867 @kindex dump srec
5868 @item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5869 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5870 srec format file @var{filename}.
5871
5872 @item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5873 Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5874
5875 @kindex dump tekhex
5876 @item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5877 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5878 tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5879
5880 @item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5881 Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5882
5883 @item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5884 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5885 command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5886 raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5887 @var{binary} after the filename.
5888
5889 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5890 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5891 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5892 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5893 from that location.
5894
5895 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5896 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5897 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5898 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5899
5900 @end table
5901
5902 @node Character Sets
5903 @section Character Sets
5904 @cindex character sets
5905 @cindex charset
5906 @cindex translating between character sets
5907 @cindex host character set
5908 @cindex target character set
5909
5910 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5911 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5912 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5913 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5914 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5915 @dfn{target character set}.
5916
5917 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5918 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5919 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5920 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5921 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5922 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5923 target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5924 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5925 character and string literals in expressions.
5926
5927 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5928 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5929 target-charset} command, described below.
5930
5931 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5932 support:
5933
5934 @table @code
5935 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
5936 @kindex set target-charset
5937 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5938 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5939 @code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5940 the character sets it supports.
5941 @end table
5942
5943 @table @code
5944 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
5945 @kindex set host-charset
5946 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5947
5948 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5949 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5950 @code{set host-charset} command.
5951
5952 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5953 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5954 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5955 @code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5956 character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5957 it can use as a host character set.
5958
5959 @item set charset @var{charset}
5960 @kindex set charset
5961 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5962 invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5963 character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5964 sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5965 asterisk (@samp{*}).
5966
5967 @item show charset
5968 @itemx show host-charset
5969 @itemx show target-charset
5970 @kindex show charset
5971 @kindex show host-charset
5972 @kindex show target-charset
5973 Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
5974 and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
5975 charset}.
5976
5977 @end table
5978
5979 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
5980 sets:
5981
5982 @table @code
5983
5984 @item ASCII
5985 @cindex ASCII character set
5986 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
5987 character set.
5988
5989 @item ISO-8859-1
5990 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
5991 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
5992 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
5993 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
5994 this as its host character set.
5995
5996 @item EBCDIC-US
5997 @itemx IBM1047
5998 @cindex EBCDIC character set
5999 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6000 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6001 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6002 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6003
6004 @end table
6005
6006 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6007 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6008 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6009
6010 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6011 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6012 @file{charset-test.c}:
6013
6014 @smallexample
6015 #include <stdio.h>
6016
6017 char ascii_hello[]
6018 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6019 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6020 char ibm1047_hello[]
6021 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6022 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6023
6024 main ()
6025 @{
6026 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6027 @}
6028 @end smallexample
6029
6030 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6031 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6032 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6033
6034 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6035
6036 @smallexample
6037 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6038 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6039 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6040 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6041 @dots{}
6042 (gdb)
6043 @end smallexample
6044
6045 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6046 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6047 strings:
6048
6049 @smallexample
6050 (gdb) show charset
6051 The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6052 (gdb)
6053 @end smallexample
6054
6055 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6056 initial character set:
6057 @smallexample
6058 (gdb) set charset ascii
6059 (gdb) show charset
6060 The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6061 (gdb)
6062 @end smallexample
6063
6064 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6065 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6066 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6067 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6068 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6072 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6073 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6074 $2 = 72 'H'
6075 (gdb)
6076 @end smallexample
6077
6078 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6079 literals you use in expressions:
6080
6081 @smallexample
6082 (gdb) print '+'
6083 $3 = 43 '+'
6084 (gdb)
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6088 character.
6089
6090 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6091 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6092 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6093
6094 @smallexample
6095 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6096 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6097 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6098 $5 = 200 '\310'
6099 (gdb)
6100 @end smallexample
6101
6102 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6103 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6104
6105 @smallexample
6106 (gdb) set target-charset
6107 Valid character sets are:
6108 ascii *
6109 iso-8859-1 *
6110 ebcdic-us
6111 ibm1047
6112 * - can be used as a host character set
6113 @end smallexample
6114
6115 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6116 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6117 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6118 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6119 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6120
6121 @smallexample
6122 (gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6123 (gdb) show charset
6124 The current host character set is `ascii'.
6125 The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6126 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6127 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6128 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6129 $7 = 72 '\110'
6130 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6131 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6132 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6133 $9 = 200 'H'
6134 (gdb)
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6138 string literals you use in expressions:
6139
6140 @smallexample
6141 (gdb) print '+'
6142 $10 = 78 '+'
6143 (gdb)
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6147 character.
6148
6149
6150 @node Macros
6151 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6152
6153 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6154 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6155 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6156 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6157 where it was defined.
6158
6159 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6160 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6161 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6162 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6163
6164 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6165 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6166 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6167 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6168 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6169 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6170 see @ref{List}.
6171
6172 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6173 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6174 variable-arity macros.
6175
6176 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6177 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6178 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6179
6180 @table @code
6181
6182 @kindex macro expand
6183 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6184 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6185 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6186 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6187 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6188 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6189 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6190 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6191 it can be any string of tokens.
6192
6193 @kindex macro expand-once
6194 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6195 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6196 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6197 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6198 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6199 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6200 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6201 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6202 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6203 can be any string of tokens.
6204
6205 @kindex info macro
6206 @cindex macro definition, showing
6207 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6208 @item info macro @var{macro}
6209 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6210 source location where that definition was established.
6211
6212 @kindex macro define
6213 @cindex user-defined macros
6214 @cindex defining macros interactively
6215 @cindex macros, user-defined
6216 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6217 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6218 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6219 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6220 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6221 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6222 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6223 given in @var{arglist}.
6224
6225 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6226 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6227 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6228 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6229 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6230
6231 @kindex macro undef
6232 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6233 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6234 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6235 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6236 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6237 debugged.
6238
6239 @end table
6240
6241 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6242 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6243 show our source files:
6244
6245 @smallexample
6246 $ cat sample.c
6247 #include <stdio.h>
6248 #include "sample.h"
6249
6250 #define M 42
6251 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6252
6253 main ()
6254 @{
6255 #define N 28
6256 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6257 #undef N
6258 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6259 #define N 1729
6260 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6261 @}
6262 $ cat sample.h
6263 #define Q <
6264 $
6265 @end smallexample
6266
6267 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6268 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6269 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6270 information.
6271
6272 @smallexample
6273 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6274 $
6275 @end smallexample
6276
6277 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6278
6279 @smallexample
6280 $ gdb -nw sample
6281 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6282 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6283 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6284 (gdb)
6285 @end smallexample
6286
6287 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6288 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6289 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6290
6291 @smallexample
6292 (gdb) list main
6293 3
6294 4 #define M 42
6295 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6296 6
6297 7 main ()
6298 8 @{
6299 9 #define N 28
6300 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6301 11 #undef N
6302 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6303 (gdb) info macro ADD
6304 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6305 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6306 (gdb) info macro Q
6307 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6308 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6309 #define Q <
6310 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6311 expands to: (42 + 1)
6312 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6313 expands to: once (M + 1)
6314 (gdb)
6315 @end smallexample
6316
6317 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6318 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6319 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6320 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6321
6322 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6323 the source line of the current stack frame:
6324
6325 @smallexample
6326 (gdb) break main
6327 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6328 (gdb) run
6329 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6330
6331 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6332 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6333 (gdb)
6334 @end smallexample
6335
6336 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6337
6338 @smallexample
6339 (gdb) info macro N
6340 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6341 #define N 28
6342 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6343 expands to: 28 < 42
6344 (gdb) print N Q M
6345 $1 = 1
6346 (gdb)
6347 @end smallexample
6348
6349 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6350 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6351 thereof) in force at each point:
6352
6353 @smallexample
6354 (gdb) next
6355 Hello, world!
6356 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6357 (gdb) info macro N
6358 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6359 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6360 (gdb) next
6361 We're so creative.
6362 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6363 (gdb) info macro N
6364 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6365 #define N 1729
6366 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6367 expands to: 1729 < 42
6368 (gdb) print N Q M
6369 $2 = 0
6370 (gdb)
6371 @end smallexample
6372
6373
6374 @node Tracepoints
6375 @chapter Tracepoints
6376 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6377 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6378
6379 @cindex tracepoints
6380 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6381 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6382 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6383 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6384 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6385 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6386 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6387
6388 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6389 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6390 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6391 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6392 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6393 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6394 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6395 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6396 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6397 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6398 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6399
6400 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6401 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6402 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6403 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6404 tracepoints as of this writing.
6405
6406 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6407
6408 @menu
6409 * Set Tracepoints::
6410 * Analyze Collected Data::
6411 * Tracepoint Variables::
6412 @end menu
6413
6414 @node Set Tracepoints
6415 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6416
6417 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6418 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6419 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6420 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6421 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6422 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6423 work on.
6424
6425 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6426 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6427 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6428 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6429 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6430 tracepoint was hit.
6431
6432 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6433 conditions and actions.
6434
6435 @menu
6436 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6437 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6438 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6439 * Tracepoint Actions::
6440 * Listing Tracepoints::
6441 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6442 @end menu
6443
6444 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6445 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6446
6447 @table @code
6448 @cindex set tracepoint
6449 @kindex trace
6450 @item trace
6451 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6452 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6453 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6454 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6455 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6456 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6457 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6458 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6459 running.
6460
6461 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6462
6463 @smallexample
6464 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6465
6466 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6467
6468 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6469
6470 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6471
6472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6473 @end smallexample
6474
6475 @noindent
6476 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6477
6478 @vindex $tpnum
6479 @cindex last tracepoint number
6480 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6481 @cindex tracepoint number
6482 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6483 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6484
6485 @kindex delete tracepoint
6486 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6487 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6488 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6489 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6490
6491 Examples:
6492
6493 @smallexample
6494 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6495
6496 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6497 @end smallexample
6498
6499 @noindent
6500 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6501 @end table
6502
6503 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6504 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6505
6506 @table @code
6507 @kindex disable tracepoint
6508 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6509 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6510 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6511 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6512 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6513
6514 @kindex enable tracepoint
6515 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6516 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6517 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6518 run.
6519 @end table
6520
6521 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6522 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6523
6524 @table @code
6525 @kindex passcount
6526 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6527 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6528 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6529 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6530 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6531 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6532 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6533 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6534 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6535 user.
6536
6537 Examples:
6538
6539 @smallexample
6540 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6541 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6542
6543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6544 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6545 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6547 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6548 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6549 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6550 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6551 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6552 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6553 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6554 @end smallexample
6555 @end table
6556
6557 @node Tracepoint Actions
6558 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6559
6560 @table @code
6561 @kindex actions
6562 @cindex tracepoint actions
6563 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6564 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6565 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6566 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6567 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6568 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6569 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6570 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6571 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6572 @code{while-stepping}.
6573
6574 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6575 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6576 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6577
6578 @smallexample
6579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6580
6581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6582
6583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6584 @end smallexample
6585
6586 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6587 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6588 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6589 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6590 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6591 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6592 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6593 @code{end} command.
6594
6595 @smallexample
6596 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6597 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6598 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6599 > collect bar,baz
6600 > collect $regs
6601 > while-stepping 12
6602 > collect $fp, $sp
6603 > end
6604 end
6605 @end smallexample
6606
6607 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6608 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6609 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6610 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6611 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6612 special arguments are supported:
6613
6614 @table @code
6615 @item $regs
6616 collect all registers
6617
6618 @item $args
6619 collect all function arguments
6620
6621 @item $locals
6622 collect all local variables.
6623 @end table
6624
6625 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6626 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6627 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6628
6629 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6630 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6631
6632 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6633 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6634 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6635 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6636 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6637 its own @code{end} command):
6638
6639 @smallexample
6640 > while-stepping 12
6641 > collect $regs, myglobal
6642 > end
6643 >
6644 @end smallexample
6645
6646 @noindent
6647 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6648 @code{stepping}.
6649 @end table
6650
6651 @node Listing Tracepoints
6652 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6653
6654 @table @code
6655 @kindex info tracepoints
6656 @cindex information about tracepoints
6657 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6658 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6659 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6660 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6661 shown:
6662
6663 @itemize @bullet
6664 @item
6665 its number
6666 @item
6667 whether it is enabled or disabled
6668 @item
6669 its address
6670 @item
6671 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6672 @item
6673 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6674 @item
6675 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6676 @item
6677 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6678 @end itemize
6679
6680 @smallexample
6681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6682 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6683 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6684 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6685 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6686 (@value{GDBP})
6687 @end smallexample
6688
6689 @noindent
6690 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6691 @end table
6692
6693 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6694 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6695
6696 @table @code
6697 @kindex tstart
6698 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6699 @cindex collected data discarded
6700 @item tstart
6701 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6702 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6703 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6704 experiment.
6705
6706 @kindex tstop
6707 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6708 @item tstop
6709 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6710 stops collecting data.
6711
6712 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6713 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6714 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6715
6716 @kindex tstatus
6717 @cindex status of trace data collection
6718 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6719 @item tstatus
6720 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6721 collection.
6722 @end table
6723
6724 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6725
6726 @smallexample
6727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6729 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6730 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6731 > while-stepping 11
6732 > collect $regs
6733 > end
6734 > end
6735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6736 [time passes @dots{}]
6737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6738 @end smallexample
6739
6740
6741 @node Analyze Collected Data
6742 @section Using the collected data
6743
6744 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6745 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6746 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6747 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6748 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6749 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6750 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6751 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6752 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6753 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6754 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6755 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6756 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6757 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6758 the buffer will fail.
6759
6760 @menu
6761 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6762 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6763 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6764 @end menu
6765
6766 @node tfind
6767 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6768
6769 @kindex tfind
6770 @cindex select trace snapshot
6771 @cindex find trace snapshot
6772 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6773 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6774 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6775 snapshot is selected.
6776
6777 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6778
6779 @table @code
6780 @item tfind start
6781 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6782 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6783
6784 @item tfind none
6785 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6786
6787 @item tfind end
6788 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6789
6790 @item tfind
6791 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6792
6793 @item tfind -
6794 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6795 retracing earlier steps.
6796
6797 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6798 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6799 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6800 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6801 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6802
6803 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6804 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6805 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6806 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6807 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6808
6809 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6810 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6811 addresses.
6812
6813 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6814 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6815 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6816
6817 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6818 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6819 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6820 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6821 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6822 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6823 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6824 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6825 @end table
6826
6827 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6828 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6829 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6830 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6831 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6832 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6833 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6834 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6835 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6836 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6837 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6838 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6839 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6840 tracepoint as the current one.
6841
6842 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6843 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6844 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6845 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6846 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6847
6848 @smallexample
6849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6850 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6851 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6852 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6853 > tfind
6854 > end
6855
6856 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6857 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6858 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6859 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6860 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6861 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6862 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6863 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6864 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6865 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6866 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6870 the buffer:
6871
6872 @smallexample
6873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6875 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6876 > tfind line
6877 > end
6878
6879 Frame 0, X = 1
6880 Frame 7, X = 2
6881 Frame 13, X = 255
6882 @end smallexample
6883
6884 @node tdump
6885 @subsection @code{tdump}
6886 @kindex tdump
6887 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6888 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6889
6890 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6891 the current trace snapshot.
6892
6893 @smallexample
6894 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6895 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6896 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6897 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6898 > end
6899
6900 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6901
6902 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6903 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6904 at gdb_test.c:444
6905 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6906
6907 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6908 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6909 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6910 d1 0x18 24
6911 d2 0x80 128
6912 d3 0x33 51
6913 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6914 d5 0x22 34
6915 d6 0xe0 224
6916 d7 0x380035 3670069
6917 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6918 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6919 a2 0x100 256
6920 a3 0x322000 3284992
6921 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6922 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6923 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6924 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6925 ps 0x0 0
6926 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6927 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6928 fpstatus 0x0 0
6929 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6930 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6931 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6932 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6933 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6934 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6935 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6936 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6937 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6938
6939 (@value{GDBP})
6940 @end smallexample
6941
6942 @node save-tracepoints
6943 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6944 @kindex save-tracepoints
6945 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6946
6947 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6948 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6949 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6950 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6951 Files}).
6952
6953 @node Tracepoint Variables
6954 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6955 @cindex tracepoint variables
6956 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6957
6958 @table @code
6959 @vindex $trace_frame
6960 @item (int) $trace_frame
6961 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6962 snapshot is selected.
6963
6964 @vindex $tracepoint
6965 @item (int) $tracepoint
6966 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6967
6968 @vindex $trace_line
6969 @item (int) $trace_line
6970 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6971
6972 @vindex $trace_file
6973 @item (char []) $trace_file
6974 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6975
6976 @vindex $trace_func
6977 @item (char []) $trace_func
6978 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6979 @end table
6980
6981 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6982 use @code{output} instead.
6983
6984 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6985 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6986 data.
6987
6988 @smallexample
6989 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6990
6991 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6992 > output $trace_file
6993 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6994 > tfind
6995 > end
6996 @end smallexample
6997
6998 @node Overlays
6999 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7000 @cindex overlays
7001
7002 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7003 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7004 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7005 use overlays.
7006
7007 @menu
7008 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7009 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7010 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7011 mapped by asking the inferior.
7012 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7013 @end menu
7014
7015 @node How Overlays Work
7016 @section How Overlays Work
7017 @cindex mapped overlays
7018 @cindex unmapped overlays
7019 @cindex load address, overlay's
7020 @cindex mapped address
7021 @cindex overlay area
7022
7023 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7024 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7025 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7026 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7027 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7028
7029 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7030 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7031 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7032 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7033 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7034 largest overlay as well.
7035
7036 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7037 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7038 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7039 there.
7040
7041 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7042 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7043 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7044
7045 @smallexample
7046 @group
7047 Data Instruction Larger
7048 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7049 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7050 | | | | | |
7051 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7052 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7053 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7054 | and heap | | | | | |
7055 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7056 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7057 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7058 | | | | | |
7059 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7060 address | | | | | |
7061 | overlay | <-' | | |
7062 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7063 | | <---. | | load address
7064 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7065 | | | |
7066 +-----------+ | |
7067 +-----------+
7068 | |
7069 +-----------+
7070
7071 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7072 @end group
7073 @end smallexample
7074
7075 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7076 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7077 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7078 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7079 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7080 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7081 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7082 program and the overlay area.
7083
7084 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7085 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7086 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7087 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7088 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7089 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7090 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7091
7092 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7093 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7094 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7095
7096 @itemize @bullet
7097
7098 @item
7099 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7100 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7101 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7102 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7103
7104 @item
7105 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7106 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7107 your program's performance.
7108
7109 @item
7110 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7111 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7112 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7113 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7114 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7115 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7116 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7117
7118 @item
7119 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7120 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7121 instruction and data spaces.
7122
7123 @end itemize
7124
7125 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7126 improved in many ways:
7127
7128 @itemize @bullet
7129
7130 @item
7131 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7132 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7133 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7134 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7135 area in the usual way.
7136
7137 @item
7138 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7139 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7140
7141 @item
7142 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7143 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7144 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7145 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7146 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7147 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7148 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7149
7150 @end itemize
7151
7152
7153 @node Overlay Commands
7154 @section Overlay Commands
7155
7156 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7157 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7158 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7159 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7160 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7161 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7162
7163 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7164 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7165
7166 @table @code
7167 @item overlay off
7168 @kindex overlay off
7169 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7170 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7171 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7172 overlay support is disabled.
7173
7174 @item overlay manual
7175 @kindex overlay manual
7176 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7177 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7178 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7179 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7180 commands described below.
7181
7182 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7183 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7184 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7185 @cindex map an overlay
7186 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7187 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7188 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7189 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7190 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7191 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7192
7193 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7194 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7195 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7196 @cindex unmap an overlay
7197 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7198 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7199 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7200 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7201
7202 @item overlay auto
7203 @kindex overlay auto
7204 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7205 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7206 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7207 Overlay Debugging}.
7208
7209 @item overlay load-target
7210 @itemx overlay load
7211 @kindex overlay load-target
7212 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7213 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7214 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7215 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7216 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7217 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7218
7219 @item overlay list-overlays
7220 @itemx overlay list
7221 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7222 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7223 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7224
7225 @end table
7226
7227 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7228 of the function the address falls in:
7229
7230 @smallexample
7231 (gdb) print main
7232 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7233 @end smallexample
7234 @noindent
7235 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7236 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7237 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7238 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7239
7240 @smallexample
7241 (gdb) overlay list
7242 No sections are mapped.
7243 (gdb) print foo
7244 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7245 @end smallexample
7246 @noindent
7247 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7248 name normally:
7249
7250 @smallexample
7251 (gdb) overlay list
7252 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7253 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7254 (gdb) print foo
7255 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7256 @end smallexample
7257
7258 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7259 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7260 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7261 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7262 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7263
7264 @itemize @bullet
7265 @item
7266 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7267 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7268 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7269 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7270 @item
7271 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7272 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7273 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7274 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7275 breakpoints properly.
7276 @end itemize
7277
7278
7279 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7280 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7281 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7282
7283 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7284 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7285 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7286 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7287 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7288 current state of the overlays.
7289
7290 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7291 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7292
7293 @table @asis
7294
7295 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7296 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7297
7298 @smallexample
7299 struct
7300 @{
7301 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7302 unsigned long vma;
7303
7304 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7305 unsigned long size;
7306
7307 /* The overlay's load address. */
7308 unsigned long lma;
7309
7310 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7311 zero otherwise. */
7312 unsigned long mapped;
7313 @}
7314 @end smallexample
7315
7316 @item @code{_novlys}:
7317 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7318 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7319
7320 @end table
7321
7322 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7323 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7324 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7325 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7326 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7327 currently mapped.
7328
7329 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7330 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7331 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7332 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7333 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7334 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7335 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7336 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7337 are not being executed.
7338
7339 @node Overlay Sample Program
7340 @section Overlay Sample Program
7341 @cindex overlay example program
7342
7343 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7344 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7345 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7346 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7347 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7348 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7349 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7350
7351 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7352 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7353 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7354 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7355
7356 @table @file
7357 @item overlays.c
7358 The main program file.
7359 @item ovlymgr.c
7360 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7361 @item foo.c
7362 @itemx bar.c
7363 @itemx baz.c
7364 @itemx grbx.c
7365 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7366 @item d10v.ld
7367 @itemx m32r.ld
7368 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7369 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7370 @end table
7371
7372 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7373 cross-compiler like this:
7374
7375 @smallexample
7376 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7377 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7378 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7379 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7380 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7381 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7382 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7383 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7384 @end smallexample
7385
7386 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7387 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7388 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7389
7390
7391 @node Languages
7392 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7393 @cindex languages
7394
7395 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7396 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7397 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7398 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7399 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7400 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7401
7402 @cindex working language
7403 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7404 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7405 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7406 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7407 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7408 language}.
7409
7410 @menu
7411 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7412 * Show:: Displaying the language
7413 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7414 * Support:: Supported languages
7415 @end menu
7416
7417 @node Setting
7418 @section Switching between source languages
7419
7420 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7421 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7422 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7423 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7424 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7425 are printed, etc.
7426
7427 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7428 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7429 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7430 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7431 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7432 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7433 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7434 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7435 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7436 Displaying the language}.
7437
7438 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7439 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7440 another language. In that case, make the
7441 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7442 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7443 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7444
7445 @menu
7446 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7447 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7448 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7449 @end menu
7450
7451 @node Filenames
7452 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7453
7454 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7455 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7456
7457 @table @file
7458
7459 @item .c
7460 C source file
7461
7462 @item .C
7463 @itemx .cc
7464 @itemx .cp
7465 @itemx .cpp
7466 @itemx .cxx
7467 @itemx .c++
7468 C@t{++} source file
7469
7470 @item .f
7471 @itemx .F
7472 Fortran source file
7473
7474 @item .mod
7475 Modula-2 source file
7476
7477 @item .s
7478 @itemx .S
7479 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7480 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7481 @end table
7482
7483 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7484 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7485
7486 @node Manually
7487 @subsection Setting the working language
7488
7489 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7490 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7491 your program.
7492
7493 @kindex set language
7494 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7495 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7496 a language, such as
7497 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7498 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7499
7500 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7501 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7502 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7503 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7504 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7505 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7506 command such as:
7507
7508 @smallexample
7509 print a = b + c
7510 @end smallexample
7511
7512 @noindent
7513 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7514 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7515 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7516 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7517
7518 @node Automatically
7519 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7520
7521 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7522 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7523 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7524 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7525 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7526 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7527 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7528 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7529 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7530
7531 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7532 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7533 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7534 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7535 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7536
7537 @node Show
7538 @section Displaying the language
7539
7540 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7541 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7542
7543 @kindex show language
7544 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7545 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7546 @table @code
7547 @item show language
7548 Display the current working language. This is the
7549 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7550 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7551
7552 @item info frame
7553 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7554 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7555 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7556 information listed here.
7557
7558 @item info source
7559 Display the source language of this source file.
7560 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7561 information listed here.
7562 @end table
7563
7564 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7565 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7566 with a language explicitly:
7567
7568 @kindex set extension-language
7569 @kindex info extensions
7570 @table @code
7571 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7572 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7573 the source language @var{language}.
7574
7575 @item info extensions
7576 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7577 @end table
7578
7579 @node Checks
7580 @section Type and range checking
7581
7582 @quotation
7583 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7584 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7585 section documents the intended facilities.
7586 @end quotation
7587 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7588
7589 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7590 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7591 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7592 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7593 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7594 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7595 errors when your program is running.
7596
7597 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7598 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7599 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7600 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7601 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7602 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7603 for the default settings of supported languages.
7604
7605 @menu
7606 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7607 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7608 @end menu
7609
7610 @cindex type checking
7611 @cindex checks, type
7612 @node Type Checking
7613 @subsection An overview of type checking
7614
7615 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7616 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7617 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7618 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7619
7620 @smallexample
7621 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7622 @exdent but
7623 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7624 @end smallexample
7625
7626 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7627 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7628
7629 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7630 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7631 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7632 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7633 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7634 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7635 also issues a warning.
7636
7637 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7638 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7639 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7640 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7641 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7642 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7643
7644 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7645 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7646 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7647 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7648 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7649 details on specific languages.
7650
7651 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7652
7653 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7654 @kindex set check type
7655 @kindex show check type
7656 @table @code
7657 @item set check type auto
7658 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7659 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7660 each language.
7661
7662 @item set check type on
7663 @itemx set check type off
7664 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7665 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7666 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7667 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7668 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7669
7670 @item set check type warn
7671 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7672 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7673 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7674 numbers and structures.
7675
7676 @item show type
7677 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7678 is setting it automatically.
7679 @end table
7680
7681 @cindex range checking
7682 @cindex checks, range
7683 @node Range Checking
7684 @subsection An overview of range checking
7685
7686 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7687 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7688 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7689 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7690 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7691
7692 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7693 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7694 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7695 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7696
7697 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7698 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7699 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7700 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7701 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7702 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7703
7704 @smallexample
7705 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7706 @end smallexample
7707
7708 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7709 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7710 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7711
7712 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7713
7714 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7715 @kindex set check range
7716 @kindex show check range
7717 @table @code
7718 @item set check range auto
7719 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7720 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7721 each language.
7722
7723 @item set check range on
7724 @itemx set check range off
7725 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7726 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7727 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7728 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7729
7730 @item set check range warn
7731 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7732 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7733 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7734 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7735 systems).
7736
7737 @item show range
7738 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7739 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7740 @end table
7741
7742 @node Support
7743 @section Supported languages
7744
7745 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
7746 @c This is false ...
7747 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7748 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7749 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7750 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7751 language.
7752
7753 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7754 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7755 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7756 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7757 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7758 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7759 language reference or tutorial.
7760
7761 @menu
7762 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7763 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7764 @end menu
7765
7766 @node C
7767 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7768
7769 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7770 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7771
7772 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7773 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7774 together.
7775
7776 @cindex C@t{++}
7777 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7778 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7779 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7780 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7781 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7782 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7783 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7784
7785 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
7786 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7787 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7788 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7789 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
7790
7791 @menu
7792 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7793 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7794 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7795 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7796 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7797 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7798 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7799 @end menu
7800
7801 @node C Operators
7802 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7803
7804 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7805
7806 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7807 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7808 often defined on groups of types.
7809
7810 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7811
7812 @itemize @bullet
7813
7814 @item
7815 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7816 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7817
7818 @item
7819 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7820 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7821
7822 @item
7823 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7824
7825 @item
7826 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7827
7828 @end itemize
7829
7830 @noindent
7831 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7832 in order of increasing precedence:
7833
7834 @table @code
7835 @item ,
7836 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7837 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7838 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7839
7840 @item =
7841 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7842 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7843
7844 @item @var{op}=
7845 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7846 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7847 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7848 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7849 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7850
7851 @item ?:
7852 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7853 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7854 integral type.
7855
7856 @item ||
7857 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7858
7859 @item &&
7860 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7861
7862 @item |
7863 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7864
7865 @item ^
7866 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7867
7868 @item &
7869 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7870
7871 @item ==@r{, }!=
7872 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7873 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7874
7875 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7876 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7877 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7878 and non-zero for true.
7879
7880 @item <<@r{, }>>
7881 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7882
7883 @item @@
7884 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7885
7886 @item +@r{, }-
7887 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7888 pointer types.
7889
7890 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7891 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7892 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7893 integral types.
7894
7895 @item ++@r{, }--
7896 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7897 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7898 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7899 operation takes place.
7900
7901 @item *
7902 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7903 @code{++}.
7904
7905 @item &
7906 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7907
7908 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7909 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7910 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7911 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7912 stored.
7913
7914 @item -
7915 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7916 precedence as @code{++}.
7917
7918 @item !
7919 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7920 @code{++}.
7921
7922 @item ~
7923 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7924 @code{++}.
7925
7926
7927 @item .@r{, }->
7928 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7929 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7930 pointer based on the stored type information.
7931 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7932
7933 @item .*@r{, }->*
7934 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7935
7936 @item []
7937 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7938 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7939
7940 @item ()
7941 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7942
7943 @item ::
7944 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7945 and @code{class} types.
7946
7947 @item ::
7948 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7949 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7950 above.
7951 @end table
7952
7953 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7954 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7955 predefined meaning.
7956
7957 @menu
7958 * C Constants::
7959 @end menu
7960
7961 @node C Constants
7962 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
7963
7964 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
7965
7966 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
7967 following ways:
7968
7969 @itemize @bullet
7970 @item
7971 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
7972 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7973 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
7974 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7975 @code{long} value.
7976
7977 @item
7978 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7979 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7980 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7981 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7982 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
7983 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7984 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7985 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7986 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7987 constant.
7988
7989 @item
7990 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7991 integral equivalents.
7992
7993 @item
7994 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7995 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
7996 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
7997 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7998 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7999 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8000 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8001 @samp{\n} for newline.
8002
8003 @item
8004 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8005 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8006 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8007 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8008 characters.
8009
8010 @item
8011 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8012 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8013
8014 @item
8015 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8016 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8017 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8018 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8019 @end itemize
8020
8021 @menu
8022 * C plus plus expressions::
8023 * C Defaults::
8024 * C Checks::
8025
8026 * Debugging C::
8027 @end menu
8028
8029 @node C plus plus expressions
8030 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8031
8032 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8033 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8034
8035 @cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8036 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8037 @cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8038 @cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8039 @cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8040 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8041 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8042 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8043 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
8044 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8045 @c periodically whether this has happened...
8046 @quotation
8047 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8048 proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
8049 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8050 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8051 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8052 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8053 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8054 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
8055 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
8056 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8057 @end quotation
8058
8059 @enumerate
8060
8061 @cindex member functions
8062 @item
8063 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8064
8065 @smallexample
8066 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8067 @end smallexample
8068
8069 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8070 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8071 @item
8072 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8073 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8074 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8075 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8076
8077 @cindex call overloaded functions
8078 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8079 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8080 @item
8081 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8082 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8083 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8084 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8085 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8086 default arguments.
8087
8088 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8089 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8090 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8091 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8092 number of function arguments.
8093
8094 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8095 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8096 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8097
8098 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8099 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8100 @smallexample
8101 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8102 @end smallexample
8103
8104 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8105 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8106
8107 @cindex reference declarations
8108 @item
8109 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8110 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8111 dereferenced.
8112
8113 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8114 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8115 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8116 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8117 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8118
8119 @item
8120 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8121 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8122 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8123 necessary, for example in an expression like
8124 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8125 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8126 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8127 @end enumerate
8128
8129 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8130 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8131 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8132 invoking user-defined operators.
8133
8134 @node C Defaults
8135 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8136
8137 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8138
8139 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8140 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8141 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8142 selects the working language.
8143
8144 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8145 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8146 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8147 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8148 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8149 for further details.
8150
8151 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8152 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8153 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8154
8155 @node C Checks
8156 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8157
8158 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8159
8160 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8161 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8162 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8163
8164 @itemize @bullet
8165 @item
8166 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8167 enumerated tag.
8168
8169 @item
8170 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8171 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8172
8173 @ignore
8174 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8175 @c FIXME--beers?
8176 @item
8177 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8178 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8179 compilers.)
8180 @end ignore
8181 @end itemize
8182
8183 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8184 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8185 that is not itself an array.
8186
8187 @node Debugging C
8188 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8189
8190 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8191 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8192 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8193 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8194
8195 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8196 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8197 ,Expressions}.
8198
8199 @menu
8200 * Debugging C plus plus::
8201 @end menu
8202
8203 @node Debugging C plus plus
8204 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8205
8206 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8207
8208 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8209 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8210
8211 @table @code
8212 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8213 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8214 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8215 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8216 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8217
8218 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8219 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8220 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8221 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8222 classes.
8223 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8224
8225 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8226 @item catch throw
8227 @itemx catch catch
8228 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8229 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8230
8231 @cindex inheritance
8232 @item ptype @var{typename}
8233 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8234 @var{typename}.
8235 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8236
8237 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8238 @item set print demangle
8239 @itemx show print demangle
8240 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8241 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8242 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8243 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8244 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8245
8246 @item set print object
8247 @itemx show print object
8248 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8249 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8250
8251 @item set print vtbl
8252 @itemx show print vtbl
8253 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8254 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8255 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8256 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8257
8258 @kindex set overload-resolution
8259 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8260 @item set overload-resolution on
8261 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8262 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8263 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8264 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8265 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8266 message.
8267
8268 @item set overload-resolution off
8269 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8270 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8271 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8272 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8273 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8274 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8275 argument types.
8276
8277 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8278 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8279 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8280 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8281 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8282 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8283 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8284 @end table
8285
8286 @node Modula-2
8287 @subsection Modula-2
8288
8289 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8290
8291 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8292 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8293 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8294 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8295 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8296 table.
8297
8298 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8299 @menu
8300 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8301 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8302 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8303 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8304 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8305 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8306 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8307 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8308 @end menu
8309
8310 @node M2 Operators
8311 @subsubsection Operators
8312 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8313
8314 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8315 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8316 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8317 following definitions hold:
8318
8319 @itemize @bullet
8320
8321 @item
8322 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8323 their subranges.
8324
8325 @item
8326 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8327
8328 @item
8329 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8330
8331 @item
8332 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8333 @var{type}}.
8334
8335 @item
8336 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8337
8338 @item
8339 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8340
8341 @item
8342 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8343 @end itemize
8344
8345 @noindent
8346 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8347 increasing precedence:
8348
8349 @table @code
8350 @item ,
8351 Function argument or array index separator.
8352
8353 @item :=
8354 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8355 @var{value}.
8356
8357 @item <@r{, }>
8358 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8359 types.
8360
8361 @item <=@r{, }>=
8362 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8363 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8364 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8365
8366 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8367 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8368 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8369 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8370 comment character.
8371
8372 @item IN
8373 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8374 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8375
8376 @item OR
8377 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8378
8379 @item AND@r{, }&
8380 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8381
8382 @item @@
8383 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8384
8385 @item +@r{, }-
8386 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8387 and difference on set types.
8388
8389 @item *
8390 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8391 on set types.
8392
8393 @item /
8394 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8395 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8396
8397 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8398 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8399 precedence as @code{*}.
8400
8401 @item -
8402 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8403
8404 @item ^
8405 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8406
8407 @item NOT
8408 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8409 @code{^}.
8410
8411 @item .
8412 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8413 precedence as @code{^}.
8414
8415 @item []
8416 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8417
8418 @item ()
8419 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8420 as @code{^}.
8421
8422 @item ::@r{, }.
8423 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8424 @end table
8425
8426 @quotation
8427 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8428 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8429 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8430 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8431 @end quotation
8432
8433
8434 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8435 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8436 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8437
8438 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8439 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8440
8441 @table @var
8442
8443 @item a
8444 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8445
8446 @item c
8447 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8448
8449 @item i
8450 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8451
8452 @item m
8453 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8454 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8455 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8456
8457 @item n
8458 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8459
8460 @item r
8461 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8462
8463 @item t
8464 represents a type.
8465
8466 @item v
8467 represents a variable.
8468
8469 @item x
8470 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8471 explanation of the function for details.
8472 @end table
8473
8474 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8475
8476 @table @code
8477 @item ABS(@var{n})
8478 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8479
8480 @item CAP(@var{c})
8481 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8482 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8483
8484 @item CHR(@var{i})
8485 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8486
8487 @item DEC(@var{v})
8488 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8489
8490 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8491 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8492 new value.
8493
8494 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8495 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8496 set.
8497
8498 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8499 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8500
8501 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8502 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8503
8504 @item INC(@var{v})
8505 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8506
8507 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8508 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8509 new value.
8510
8511 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8512 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8513 there. Returns the new set.
8514
8515 @item MAX(@var{t})
8516 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8517
8518 @item MIN(@var{t})
8519 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8520
8521 @item ODD(@var{i})
8522 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8523
8524 @item ORD(@var{x})
8525 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8526 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8527 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8528 integral, character and enumerated types.
8529
8530 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8531 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8532
8533 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8534 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8535
8536 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8537 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8538 @end table
8539
8540 @quotation
8541 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8542 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8543 an error.
8544 @end quotation
8545
8546 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8547 @node M2 Constants
8548 @subsubsection Constants
8549
8550 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8551 ways:
8552
8553 @itemize @bullet
8554
8555 @item
8556 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8557 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8558 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8559 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8560
8561 @item
8562 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8563 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8564 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8565 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8566 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8567 digits.
8568
8569 @item
8570 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8571 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8572 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8573 followed by a @samp{C}.
8574
8575 @item
8576 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8577 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8578 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8579 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8580 sequences.
8581
8582 @item
8583 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8584
8585 @item
8586 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8587 @code{FALSE}.
8588
8589 @item
8590 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8591
8592 @item
8593 Set constants are not yet supported.
8594 @end itemize
8595
8596 @node M2 Defaults
8597 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8598 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8599
8600 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8601 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8602 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8603 selected the working language.
8604
8605 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8606 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8607 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8608 the language automatically}, for further details.
8609
8610 @node Deviations
8611 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8612 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8613
8614 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8615 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8616
8617 @itemize @bullet
8618 @item
8619 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8620 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8621 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8622 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8623 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8624 returned a pointer.)
8625
8626 @item
8627 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8628 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8629 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8630 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8631
8632 @item
8633 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8634 argument.
8635
8636 @item
8637 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8638 @end itemize
8639
8640 @node M2 Checks
8641 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8642 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8643
8644 @quotation
8645 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8646 range checking.
8647 @end quotation
8648 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8649
8650 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8651
8652 @itemize @bullet
8653 @item
8654 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8655 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8656
8657 @item
8658 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8659 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8660 @end itemize
8661
8662 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8663 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8664
8665 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8666 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8667
8668 @node M2 Scope
8669 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8670 @cindex scope
8671 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8672 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8673 @ifinfo
8674 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8675 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8676 @end ifinfo
8677 @iftex
8678 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8679 @end iftex
8680
8681 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8682 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8683 similar syntax:
8684
8685 @smallexample
8686
8687 @var{module} . @var{id}
8688 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8689 @end smallexample
8690
8691 @noindent
8692 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8693 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8694 identifier within your program, except another module.
8695
8696 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8697 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8698 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8699 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8700
8701 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8702 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8703 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8704 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8705 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8706 @var{module}.
8707
8708 @node GDB/M2
8709 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8710
8711 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8712 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8713 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8714 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8715 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8716 analogue in Modula-2.
8717
8718 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8719 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8720 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8721 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8722 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8723 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8724
8725 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8726 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8727 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8728
8729 @node Symbols
8730 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8731
8732 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8733 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8734 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8735 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8736 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8737 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8738 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8739
8740 @cindex symbol names
8741 @cindex names of symbols
8742 @cindex quoting names
8743 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8744 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8745 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8746 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8747 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8748 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8749 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8750 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8751
8752 @smallexample
8753 p 'foo.c'::x
8754 @end smallexample
8755
8756 @noindent
8757 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8758
8759 @table @code
8760 @kindex info address
8761 @cindex address of a symbol
8762 @item info address @var{symbol}
8763 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8764 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8765 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8766 is always stored.
8767
8768 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8769 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8770 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8771
8772 @kindex info symbol
8773 @cindex symbol from address
8774 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8775 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8776 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8777 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8778
8779 @smallexample
8780 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8781 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8782 @end smallexample
8783
8784 @noindent
8785 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8786 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8787
8788 @kindex whatis
8789 @item whatis @var{expr}
8790 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8791 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8792 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8793 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8794
8795 @item whatis
8796 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8797
8798 @kindex ptype
8799 @item ptype @var{typename}
8800 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8801 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8802 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8803 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8804
8805 @item ptype @var{expr}
8806 @itemx ptype
8807 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8808 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8809 of just the name of the type.
8810
8811 For example, for this variable declaration:
8812
8813 @smallexample
8814 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 @noindent
8818 the two commands give this output:
8819
8820 @smallexample
8821 @group
8822 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8823 type = struct complex
8824 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8825 type = struct complex @{
8826 double real;
8827 double imag;
8828 @}
8829 @end group
8830 @end smallexample
8831
8832 @noindent
8833 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8834 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8835
8836 @kindex info types
8837 @item info types @var{regexp}
8838 @itemx info types
8839 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
8840 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8841 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8842 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
8843 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
8844 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8845
8846 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8847 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8848 lists all source files where a type is defined.
8849
8850 @kindex info scope
8851 @cindex local variables
8852 @item info scope @var{addr}
8853 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8854 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8855 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8856 scope defined by that location. For example:
8857
8858 @smallexample
8859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8860 Scope for command_line_handler:
8861 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8862 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8863 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8864 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8865 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8866 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8867 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8868 @end smallexample
8869
8870 @noindent
8871 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8872 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8873 collect}.
8874
8875 @kindex info source
8876 @item info source
8877 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8878 the function containing the current point of execution:
8879 @itemize @bullet
8880 @item
8881 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8882 @item
8883 the directory it was compiled in,
8884 @item
8885 its length, in lines,
8886 @item
8887 which programming language it is written in,
8888 @item
8889 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8890 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8891 @item
8892 whether the debugging information includes information about
8893 preprocessor macros.
8894 @end itemize
8895
8896
8897 @kindex info sources
8898 @item info sources
8899 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8900 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8901 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8902
8903 @kindex info functions
8904 @item info functions
8905 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8906
8907 @item info functions @var{regexp}
8908 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8909 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8910 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8911 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8912 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8913 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8914 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
8915
8916 @kindex info variables
8917 @item info variables
8918 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8919 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
8920
8921 @item info variables @var{regexp}
8922 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8923 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8924 @var{regexp}.
8925
8926 @ignore
8927 This was never implemented.
8928 @kindex info methods
8929 @item info methods
8930 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8931 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
8932 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8933 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8934 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
8935 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8936 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8937 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8938 @end ignore
8939
8940 @cindex reloading symbols
8941 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
8942 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8943 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8944 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8945 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
8946
8947 @table @code
8948 @kindex set symbol-reloading
8949 @item set symbol-reloading on
8950 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8951 object file with a particular name is seen again.
8952
8953 @item set symbol-reloading off
8954 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8955 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8956 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8957 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8958 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8959 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8960 name.
8961
8962 @kindex show symbol-reloading
8963 @item show symbol-reloading
8964 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8965 @end table
8966
8967 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8968 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
8969 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8970 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8971 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8972 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8973 another source file. The default is on.
8974
8975 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8976 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8977
8978 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
8979 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8980 is printed as follows:
8981 @smallexample
8982 @{<no data fields>@}
8983 @end smallexample
8984
8985 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8986 @item show opaque-type-resolution
8987 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
8988
8989 @kindex maint print symbols
8990 @cindex symbol dump
8991 @kindex maint print psymbols
8992 @cindex partial symbol dump
8993 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8994 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8995 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8996 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8997 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8998 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8999 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9000 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9001 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9002 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9003 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9004 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9005 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9006 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9007 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9008 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9009 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9010 @end table
9011
9012 @node Altering
9013 @chapter Altering Execution
9014
9015 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9016 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9017 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9018 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9019 program.
9020
9021 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9022 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9023 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9024
9025 @menu
9026 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9027 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9028 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9029 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9030 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9031 * Patching:: Patching your program
9032 @end menu
9033
9034 @node Assignment
9035 @section Assignment to variables
9036
9037 @cindex assignment
9038 @cindex setting variables
9039 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9040 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9041
9042 @smallexample
9043 print x=4
9044 @end smallexample
9045
9046 @noindent
9047 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9048 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9049 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9050 information on operators in supported languages.
9051
9052 @kindex set variable
9053 @cindex variables, setting
9054 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9055 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9056 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9057 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9058 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9059
9060 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9061 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9062 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9063 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9064 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9065 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9066 command @code{set width}:
9067
9068 @smallexample
9069 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9070 type = double
9071 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9072 $4 = 13
9073 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9074 Invalid syntax in expression.
9075 @end smallexample
9076
9077 @noindent
9078 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9079 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9080
9081 @smallexample
9082 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9086 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9087 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9088 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9089 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9090 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9091
9092 @smallexample
9093 @group
9094 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9095 type = double
9096 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9097 $1 = 1
9098 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9099 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9100 $2 = 1
9101 (@value{GDBP}) r
9102 The program being debugged has been started already.
9103 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9104 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9105 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9106 Invalid bfd target.
9107 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9108 The current BFD target is "=4".
9109 @end group
9110 @end smallexample
9111
9112 @noindent
9113 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9114 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9115 @code{g}, use
9116
9117 @smallexample
9118 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9119 @end smallexample
9120
9121 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9122 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9123 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9124 same length or shorter.
9125 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9126 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9127
9128 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9129 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9130 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9131 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9132 and representation in memory), and
9133
9134 @smallexample
9135 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9136 @end smallexample
9137
9138 @noindent
9139 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9140
9141 @node Jumping
9142 @section Continuing at a different address
9143
9144 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9145 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9146 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9147
9148 @table @code
9149 @kindex jump
9150 @item jump @var{linespec}
9151 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9152 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9153 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9154 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9155 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9156 breakpoints}.
9157
9158 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9159 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9160 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9161 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9162 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9163 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9164 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9165 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9166 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9167
9168 @item jump *@var{address}
9169 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9170 @end table
9171
9172 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9173 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9174 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9175 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9176 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9177 example,
9178
9179 @smallexample
9180 set $pc = 0x485
9181 @end smallexample
9182
9183 @noindent
9184 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9185 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9186 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9187
9188 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9189 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9190 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9191 detail.
9192
9193 @c @group
9194 @node Signaling
9195 @section Giving your program a signal
9196
9197 @table @code
9198 @kindex signal
9199 @item signal @var{signal}
9200 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9201 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9202 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9203 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9204
9205 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9206 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9207 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9208 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9209 signal.
9210
9211 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9212 after executing the command.
9213 @end table
9214 @c @end group
9215
9216 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9217 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9218 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9219 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9220 passes the signal directly to your program.
9221
9222
9223 @node Returning
9224 @section Returning from a function
9225
9226 @table @code
9227 @cindex returning from a function
9228 @kindex return
9229 @item return
9230 @itemx return @var{expression}
9231 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9232 command. If you give an
9233 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9234 value.
9235 @end table
9236
9237 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9238 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9239 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9240 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9241
9242 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9243 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9244 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9245 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9246 of functions.
9247
9248 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9249 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9250 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9251 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9252 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9253
9254 @node Calling
9255 @section Calling program functions
9256
9257 @cindex calling functions
9258 @kindex call
9259 @table @code
9260 @item call @var{expr}
9261 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9262 returned values.
9263 @end table
9264
9265 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9266 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9267 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9268 is printed and saved in the value history.
9269
9270 @node Patching
9271 @section Patching programs
9272
9273 @cindex patching binaries
9274 @cindex writing into executables
9275 @cindex writing into corefiles
9276
9277 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9278 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9279 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9280 patching your program's binary.
9281
9282 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9283 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9284 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9285 repairs.
9286
9287 @table @code
9288 @kindex set write
9289 @item set write on
9290 @itemx set write off
9291 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9292 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9293 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9294
9295 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9296 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9297 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9298
9299 @item show write
9300 @kindex show write
9301 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9302 as well as reading.
9303 @end table
9304
9305 @node GDB Files
9306 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9307
9308 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9309 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9310 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9311 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9312
9313 @menu
9314 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9315 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9316 @end menu
9317
9318 @node Files
9319 @section Commands to specify files
9320
9321 @cindex symbol table
9322 @cindex core dump file
9323
9324 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9325 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9326 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9327 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9328
9329 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9330 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9331 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9332 to specify new files are useful.
9333
9334 @table @code
9335 @cindex executable file
9336 @kindex file
9337 @item file @var{filename}
9338 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9339 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9340 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9341 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9342 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9343 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9344 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9345 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9346
9347 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9348 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9349 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9350 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9351 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9352 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9353 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9354 for more information.
9355
9356 @item file
9357 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9358 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9359
9360 @kindex exec-file
9361 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9362 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9363 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9364 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9365 discard information on the executable file.
9366
9367 @kindex symbol-file
9368 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9369 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9370 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9371 table and program to run from the same file.
9372
9373 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9374 program's symbol table.
9375
9376 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9377 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9378 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9379 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9380 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9381
9382 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9383 executing it once.
9384
9385 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9386 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9387 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9388 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9389 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9390 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9391 optimized code.
9392
9393 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9394 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9395 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9396 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9397 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9398
9399 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9400 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9401 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9402 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9403 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9404 warnings and messages}.)
9405
9406 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9407 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9408 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9409 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9410 in stabs format.
9411
9412 @kindex readnow
9413 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9414 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9415 @kindex mapped
9416 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9417 @cindex saving symbol table
9418 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9419 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9420 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9421 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9422 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9423 entire symbol table available.
9424
9425 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9426 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9427 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9428 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9429 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9430 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9431 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9432 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9433
9434 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9435 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9436
9437 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9438 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9439 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9440 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9441 needed.
9442
9443 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9444 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9445 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9446
9447 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9448 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9449 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9450 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9451 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9452 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9453 @c files.
9454
9455 @kindex core
9456 @kindex core-file
9457 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9458 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9459 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9460 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9461 executable file itself for other parts.
9462
9463 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9464 to be used.
9465
9466 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9467 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9468 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9469 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9470 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9471
9472 @kindex add-symbol-file
9473 @cindex dynamic linking
9474 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9475 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9476 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9477 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9478 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9479 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9480 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9481 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9482 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9483 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9484 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9485 @var{address} as an expression.
9486
9487 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9488 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9489 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9490 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9491 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9492
9493 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9494 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9495 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9496 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9497 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9498 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9499 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9500 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9501 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9502
9503 @itemize @bullet
9504 @item
9505 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9506 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9507 @item
9508 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9509 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9510 @item
9511 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9512 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9513 @end itemize
9514
9515 @noindent
9516 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9517 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9518 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9519 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9520 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9521 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9522 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9523 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9524 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9525 way.
9526
9527 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9528
9529 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9530 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9531 table information for @var{filename}.
9532
9533 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9534 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9535 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9536 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9537 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9538 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9539
9540 @kindex section
9541 @item section
9542 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9543 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9544 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9545 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9546 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9547 the sections and their addresses.
9548
9549 @kindex info files
9550 @kindex info target
9551 @item info files
9552 @itemx info target
9553 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9554 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9555 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9556 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9557 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9558 current ones.
9559
9560 @kindex maint info sections
9561 @item maint info sections
9562 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9563 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9564 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9565 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9566 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9567 may be arbitrarily combined):
9568
9569 @table @code
9570 @item ALLOBJ
9571 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9572 @item @var{sections}
9573 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9574 @item @var{section-flags}
9575 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9576 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9577 @table @code
9578 @item ALLOC
9579 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9580 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9581 @item LOAD
9582 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9583 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9584 @item RELOC
9585 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9586 @item READONLY
9587 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9588 @item CODE
9589 Section contains executable code only.
9590 @item DATA
9591 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9592 @item ROM
9593 Section will reside in ROM.
9594 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9595 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9596 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9597 Section is not empty.
9598 @item NEVER_LOAD
9599 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9600 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9601 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9602 COFF shared library information.
9603 @item IS_COMMON
9604 Section contains common symbols.
9605 @end table
9606 @end table
9607 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9608 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9609 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9610 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9611 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9612 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9613 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9614 enhancement to debugging performance.
9615
9616 The default is off.
9617
9618 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9619 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9620 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9621 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9622 @end table
9623
9624 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9625 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9626 name and remembers it that way.
9627
9628 @cindex shared libraries
9629 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9630 libraries.
9631
9632 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9633 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9634 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9635 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9636 debugging a core file).
9637
9638 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9639 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9640
9641 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9642 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9643 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9644
9645 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9646 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9647 particularly large or there are many of them.
9648
9649 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9650 commands:
9651
9652 @table @code
9653 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9654 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9655 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9656 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9657 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9658 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9659 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9660 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9661
9662 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9663 @item show auto-solib-add
9664 Display the current autoloading mode.
9665 @end table
9666
9667 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9668 command:
9669
9670 @table @code
9671 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9672 @kindex info share
9673 @item info share
9674 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9675 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9676
9677 @kindex sharedlibrary
9678 @kindex share
9679 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9680 @itemx share @var{regex}
9681 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9682 Unix regular expression.
9683 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9684 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9685 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9686 loaded.
9687 @end table
9688
9689 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9690 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9691 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9692 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9693 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9694 wish.
9695
9696 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9697 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9698 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
9699 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9700
9701 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9702
9703 @table @code
9704 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
9705 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9706 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9707 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9708 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9709 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
9710 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9711 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
9712 Mb).
9713
9714 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
9715 @item show auto-solib-limit
9716 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9717 @end table
9718
9719 @node Symbol Errors
9720 @section Errors reading symbol files
9721
9722 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9723 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9724 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9725 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9726 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9727 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9728 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9729 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9730 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9731 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9732 messages}).
9733
9734 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9735
9736 @table @code
9737 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9738
9739 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9740 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9741 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9742 in its outer scope blocks.
9743
9744 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9745 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9746 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9747 function.
9748
9749 @item block at @var{address} out of order
9750
9751 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9752 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9753 do so.
9754
9755 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9756 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9757 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9758 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9759 messages}.)
9760
9761 @item bad block start address patched
9762
9763 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9764 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9765 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9766
9767 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9768 starting on the previous source line.
9769
9770 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9771
9772 @cindex foo
9773 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9774 larger than the size of the string table.
9775
9776 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9777 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9778 with this name.
9779
9780 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9781
9782 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9783 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
9784 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
9785
9786 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9787 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
9788 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
9789 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9790 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9791 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
9792
9793 @item stub type has NULL name
9794
9795 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
9796
9797 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
9798 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
9799 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9800 it.
9801
9802 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9803
9804 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
9805
9806 @end table
9807
9808 @node Targets
9809 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
9810
9811 @cindex debugging target
9812 @kindex target
9813
9814 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
9815
9816 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9817 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9818 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
9819 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9820 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
9821 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9822 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9823 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
9824
9825 @menu
9826 * Active Targets:: Active targets
9827 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
9828 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9829 * Remote:: Remote debugging
9830 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
9831
9832 @end menu
9833
9834 @node Active Targets
9835 @section Active targets
9836
9837 @cindex stacking targets
9838 @cindex active targets
9839 @cindex multiple targets
9840
9841 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
9842 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9843 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9844 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9845 a core file.
9846
9847 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9848 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9849 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9850 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9851 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9852 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9853 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9854 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9855 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
9856
9857 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
9858 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9859 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9860 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9861 process target is active.
9862
9863 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9864 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
9865 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
9866 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9867 process}).
9868
9869 @node Target Commands
9870 @section Commands for managing targets
9871
9872 @table @code
9873 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
9874 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9875 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9876 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9877 protocol of the target machine.
9878
9879 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9880 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9881 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
9882
9883 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9884 after executing the command.
9885
9886 @kindex help target
9887 @item help target
9888 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9889 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9890 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9891
9892 @item help target @var{name}
9893 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9894 select it.
9895
9896 @kindex set gnutarget
9897 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
9898 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
9899 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
9900 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9901 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
9902 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9903
9904 @quotation
9905 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9906 you must know the actual BFD name.
9907 @end quotation
9908
9909 @noindent
9910 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
9911
9912 @kindex show gnutarget
9913 @item show gnutarget
9914 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9915 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9916 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9917 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9918 @end table
9919
9920 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9921 configuration):
9922
9923 @table @code
9924 @kindex target exec
9925 @item target exec @var{program}
9926 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9927 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9928
9929 @kindex target core
9930 @item target core @var{filename}
9931 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9932 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
9933
9934 @kindex target remote
9935 @item target remote @var{dev}
9936 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9937 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9938 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
9939 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
9940 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9941 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9942
9943 @kindex target sim
9944 @item target sim
9945 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
9946 In general,
9947 @smallexample
9948 target sim
9949 load
9950 run
9951 @end smallexample
9952 @noindent
9953 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
9954 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
9955 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9956 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9957 Processors}.
9958
9959 @end table
9960
9961 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
9962
9963 @table @code
9964
9965 @kindex target nrom
9966 @item target nrom @var{dev}
9967 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9968
9969 @end table
9970
9971 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
9972 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
9973
9974 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9975 once you've successfully established a connection.
9976
9977 @table @code
9978
9979 @kindex load @var{filename}
9980 @item load @var{filename}
9981 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9982 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9983 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9984 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9985 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9986 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9987
9988 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9989 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9990 target is @dots{}}''
9991
9992 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9993 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9994 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9995 specifies a fixed address.
9996 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9997
9998 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9999 @end table
10000
10001 @node Byte Order
10002 @section Choosing target byte order
10003
10004 @cindex choosing target byte order
10005 @cindex target byte order
10006
10007 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10008 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10009 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10010 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10011 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10012 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10013
10014 @table @code
10015 @kindex set endian big
10016 @item set endian big
10017 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10018
10019 @kindex set endian little
10020 @item set endian little
10021 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10022
10023 @kindex set endian auto
10024 @item set endian auto
10025 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10026 executable.
10027
10028 @item show endian
10029 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10030
10031 @end table
10032
10033 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10034 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10035 target system.
10036
10037 @node Remote
10038 @section Remote debugging
10039 @cindex remote debugging
10040
10041 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10042 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10043 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10044 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10045 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10046
10047 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10048 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10049 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10050 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10051 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10052 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10053
10054 Other remote targets may be available in your
10055 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10056
10057 @node KOD
10058 @section Kernel Object Display
10059
10060 @cindex kernel object display
10061 @cindex kernel object
10062 @cindex KOD
10063
10064 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10065 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10066 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10067 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10068 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10069
10070 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10071 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10072
10073 @smallexample
10074 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10075 @end smallexample
10076
10077 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10078 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10079 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10080 after the operating system:
10081
10082 @smallexample
10083 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10084 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10085 Object Description
10086 any Any and all objects
10087 @end smallexample
10088
10089 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10090 by the kernel.
10091
10092 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10093 is supported other than to try it.
10094
10095
10096 @node Remote Debugging
10097 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10098
10099 @menu
10100 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10101 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10102 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10103 @end menu
10104
10105 @node Server
10106 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10107
10108 @kindex gdbserver
10109 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10110 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10111 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10112 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10113
10114 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10115 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10116 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10117 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10118 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10119 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10120 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10121 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10122 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10123 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10124 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10125 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10126 choice for debugging.
10127
10128 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10129 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10130 protocol.
10131
10132 @table @emph
10133 @item On the target machine,
10134 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10135 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10136 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10137 system does all the symbol handling.
10138
10139 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10140 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10141 syntax is:
10142
10143 @smallexample
10144 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10145 @end smallexample
10146
10147 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10148 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10149 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10150 @file{/dev/com1}:
10151
10152 @smallexample
10153 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10154 @end smallexample
10155
10156 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10157 with it.
10158
10159 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10160
10161 @smallexample
10162 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10163 @end smallexample
10164
10165 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10166 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10167 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10168 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10169 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10170 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10171 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10172 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10173 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10174 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10175 @code{target remote} command.
10176
10177 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10178 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10179
10180 @smallexample
10181 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10182 @end smallexample
10183
10184 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10185 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10186
10187 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10188 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10189 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10190 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10191 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10192 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10193 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10194 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10195 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10196 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10197
10198 @smallexample
10199 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10200 @end smallexample
10201
10202 @noindent
10203 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10204
10205 @smallexample
10206 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10207 @end smallexample
10208
10209 @noindent
10210 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10211 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10212 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10213 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10214 @samp{Connection refused}.
10215 @end table
10216
10217 @node NetWare
10218 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10219
10220 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10221 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10222 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10223 @code{target remote}.
10224
10225 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10226 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10227
10228 @table @emph
10229 @item On the target machine,
10230 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10231 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10232 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10233 host system does all the symbol handling.
10234
10235 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10236 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10237 program. The syntax is:
10238
10239 @smallexample
10240 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10241 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10242 @end smallexample
10243
10244 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10245 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10246 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10247
10248 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10249 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10250 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10251
10252 @smallexample
10253 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10254 @end smallexample
10255
10256 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10257 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10258 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10259 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10260 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10261 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10262 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10263 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10264 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10265
10266 @smallexample
10267 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10268 @end smallexample
10269
10270 @noindent
10271 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10272 @end table
10273
10274 @node remote stub
10275 @section Implementing a remote stub
10276
10277 @cindex debugging stub, example
10278 @cindex remote stub, example
10279 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10280 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10281 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10282 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10283 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10284 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10285 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10286 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10287
10288 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10289 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10290 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10291 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10292 program, you need:
10293
10294 @enumerate
10295 @item
10296 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10297 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10298 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10299
10300 @item
10301 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10302 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10303
10304 @item
10305 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10306 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10307 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10308 documentation.
10309 @end enumerate
10310
10311 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10312 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10313 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10314
10315 @table @emph
10316 @item On the host,
10317 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10318 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10319 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10320
10321 @item On the target,
10322 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10323 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10324 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10325
10326 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10327 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10328 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10329 @end table
10330
10331 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10332 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10333 @sc{sparc} boards.
10334
10335 @cindex remote serial stub list
10336 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10337
10338 @table @code
10339
10340 @item i386-stub.c
10341 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10342 @cindex Intel
10343 @cindex i386
10344 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10345
10346 @item m68k-stub.c
10347 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10348 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10349 @cindex m680x0
10350 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10351
10352 @item sh-stub.c
10353 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10354 @cindex Hitachi
10355 @cindex SH
10356 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10357
10358 @item sparc-stub.c
10359 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10360 @cindex Sparc
10361 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10362
10363 @item sparcl-stub.c
10364 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10365 @cindex Fujitsu
10366 @cindex SparcLite
10367 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10368
10369 @end table
10370
10371 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10372 recently added stubs.
10373
10374 @menu
10375 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10376 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10377 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10378 @end menu
10379
10380 @node Stub Contents
10381 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10382
10383 @cindex remote serial stub
10384 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10385 subroutines:
10386
10387 @table @code
10388 @item set_debug_traps
10389 @kindex set_debug_traps
10390 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10391 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10392 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10393 beginning of your program.
10394
10395 @item handle_exception
10396 @kindex handle_exception
10397 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10398 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10399 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10400 run when a trap is triggered.
10401
10402 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10403 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10404 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10405 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10406 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10407 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10408 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10409 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10410 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10411 machine.
10412
10413 @item breakpoint
10414 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10415 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10416 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10417 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10418 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10419 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10420 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10421 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10422 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10423 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10424 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10425
10426 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10427 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10428 start of your debugging session.
10429 @end table
10430
10431 @node Bootstrapping
10432 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10433
10434 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10435 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10436 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10437 debugging target machine.
10438
10439 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10440 serial port.
10441
10442 @table @code
10443 @item int getDebugChar()
10444 @kindex getDebugChar
10445 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10446 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10447 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10448
10449 @item void putDebugChar(int)
10450 @kindex putDebugChar
10451 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
10452 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
10453 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10454 @end table
10455
10456 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
10457 @cindex interrupting remote targets
10458 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10459 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10460 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10461 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10462 remote system to stop.
10463
10464 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10465 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10466 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10467 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10468
10469 Other routines you need to supply are:
10470
10471 @table @code
10472 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10473 @kindex exceptionHandler
10474 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10475 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10476 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10477 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10478 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10479 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10480 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10481 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10482 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10483 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10484 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10485 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10486 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10487
10488 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10489 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10490 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10491 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10492 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10493
10494 @item void flush_i_cache()
10495 @kindex flush_i_cache
10496 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
10497 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10498 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10499
10500 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10501 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10502 @end table
10503
10504 @noindent
10505 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10506
10507 @table @code
10508 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10509 @kindex memset
10510 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10511 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10512 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10513 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10514 @end table
10515
10516 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10517 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10518 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
10519 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
10520
10521
10522 @node Debug Session
10523 @subsection Putting it all together
10524
10525 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
10526 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10527 steps.
10528
10529 @enumerate
10530 @item
10531 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
10532 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10533 @display
10534 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10535 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10536 @end display
10537
10538 @item
10539 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10540
10541 @smallexample
10542 set_debug_traps();
10543 breakpoint();
10544 @end smallexample
10545
10546 @item
10547 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10548 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10549
10550 @smallexample
10551 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
10552 @end smallexample
10553
10554 @noindent
10555 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
10556 function in your program, that function is called when
10557 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10558 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10559 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10560
10561 @item
10562 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10563 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10564
10565 @item
10566 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10567 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10568
10569 @item
10570 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10571 @c document that. FIXME.
10572 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10573 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10574
10575 @item
10576 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10577 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10578 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10579 of its pure text.
10580
10581 @item
10582 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10583 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
10584 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10585 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
10586 TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
10587 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10588 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10589
10590 @smallexample
10591 target remote /dev/ttyb
10592 @end smallexample
10593
10594 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10595 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10596 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10597 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10598 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10599
10600 @smallexample
10601 target remote manyfarms:2828
10602 @end smallexample
10603
10604 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10605 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10606 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10607 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10608
10609 @smallexample
10610 target remote :1234
10611 @end smallexample
10612 @noindent
10613
10614 Note that the colon is still required here.
10615
10616 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10617 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10618 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10619 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10620
10621 @smallexample
10622 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10623 @end smallexample
10624
10625 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10626 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10627 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10628 session.
10629
10630 @end enumerate
10631
10632 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10633 step and continue the remote program.
10634
10635 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10636 command.
10637
10638 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10639 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10640 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10641 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10642 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10643 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10644 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10645
10646 @smallexample
10647 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10648 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10649 @end smallexample
10650
10651 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10652 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10653 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10654 goes back to waiting.
10655
10656
10657 @node Configurations
10658 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10659
10660 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10661 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10662 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10663
10664 There are three major categories of configurations: native
10665 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10666 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10667 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10668 are quite different from each other.
10669
10670 @menu
10671 * Native::
10672 * Embedded OS::
10673 * Embedded Processors::
10674 * Architectures::
10675 @end menu
10676
10677 @node Native
10678 @section Native
10679
10680 This section describes details specific to particular native
10681 configurations.
10682
10683 @menu
10684 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
10685 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10686 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
10687 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
10688 @end menu
10689
10690 @node HP-UX
10691 @subsection HP-UX
10692
10693 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10694 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10695 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10696
10697 @node SVR4 Process Information
10698 @subsection SVR4 process information
10699
10700 @kindex /proc
10701 @cindex process image
10702
10703 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10704 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10705 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10706 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10707 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10708 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10709 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10710 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
10711
10712 @table @code
10713 @kindex info proc
10714 @item info proc
10715 Summarize available information about the process.
10716
10717 @kindex info proc mappings
10718 @item info proc mappings
10719 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10720 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10721 @ignore
10722 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10723 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10724 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10725 @kindex info proc times
10726 @item info proc times
10727 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10728 its children.
10729
10730 @kindex info proc id
10731 @item info proc id
10732 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10733 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10734
10735 @kindex info proc status
10736 @item info proc status
10737 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10738 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10739 received.
10740
10741 @item info proc all
10742 Show all the above information about the process.
10743 @end ignore
10744 @end table
10745
10746 @node DJGPP Native
10747 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10748 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10749 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10750 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
10751
10752 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10753 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10754 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10755 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
10756
10757 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10758 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10759 subsection describes those commands.
10760
10761 @table @code
10762 @kindex info dos
10763 @item info dos
10764 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10765 information about the target system and important OS structures.
10766
10767 @kindex sysinfo
10768 @cindex MS-DOS system info
10769 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10770 @item info dos sysinfo
10771 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10772 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10773 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
10774
10775 @cindex GDT
10776 @cindex LDT
10777 @cindex IDT
10778 @cindex segment descriptor tables
10779 @cindex descriptor tables display
10780 @item info dos gdt
10781 @itemx info dos ldt
10782 @itemx info dos idt
10783 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10784 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10785 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10786 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10787 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10788 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10789 rights.
10790
10791 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10792 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10793 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10794 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10795 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
10796
10797 @cindex garbled pointers
10798 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10799 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10800 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10801 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10802 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10803 debugged program's data segment:
10804
10805 @smallexample
10806 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10807 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10808 @end smallexample
10809
10810 @noindent
10811 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10812 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
10813
10814 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10815 @item info dos pde
10816 @itemx info dos pte
10817 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10818 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10819 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10820 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10821 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10822 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10823 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10824 that is currently in use.
10825
10826 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10827 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10828 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10829 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10830 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10831 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10832 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
10833
10834 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10835 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10836 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10837 controller.
10838
10839 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
10840
10841 @cindex physical address from linear address
10842 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10843 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10844 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10845 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10846 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10847 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10848 the variable @code{i} is stored:
10849
10850 @smallexample
10851 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10852 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10853 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10854 @end smallexample
10855
10856 @noindent
10857 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10858 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10859 attributes of that page.
10860
10861 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10862 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10863 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10864 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10865 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10866 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
10867
10868 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10869 transfer buffer:
10870
10871 @smallexample
10872 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10873 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10874 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10875 @end smallexample
10876
10877 @noindent
10878 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
10879 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10880 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10881 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
10882
10883 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10884 @end table
10885
10886 @node Cygwin Native
10887 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10888 @cindex MS Windows debugging
10889 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
10890 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10891
10892 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10893 defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10894 subsection describes those commands.
10895
10896 @table @code
10897 @kindex info w32
10898 @item info w32
10899 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10900 information about the target system and important OS structures.
10901
10902 @item info w32 selector
10903 This command displays information returned by
10904 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10905 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10906 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10907 Without argument, this command displays information
10908 about the the six segment registers.
10909
10910 @kindex info dll
10911 @item info dll
10912 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10913
10914 @kindex dll-symbols
10915 @item dll-symbols
10916 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10917 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10918
10919 @kindex set new-console
10920 @item set new-console @var{mode}
10921 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10922 be started in a new console on next start.
10923 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10924 be started in the same console as the debugger.
10925
10926 @kindex show new-console
10927 @item show new-console
10928 Displays whether a new console is used
10929 when the debuggee is started.
10930
10931 @kindex set new-group
10932 @item set new-group @var{mode}
10933 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
10934 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
10935 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
10936 Ctrl-C.
10937
10938 @kindex show new-group
10939 @item show new-group
10940 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
10941
10942 @kindex set debugevents
10943 @item set debugevents
10944 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
10945
10946 @kindex set debugexec
10947 @item set debugexec
10948 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
10949 seen by the debugger.
10950
10951 @kindex set debugexceptions
10952 @item set debugexceptions
10953 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
10954 seen by the debugger.
10955
10956 @kindex set debugmemory
10957 @item set debugmemory
10958 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
10959 seen by the debugger.
10960
10961 @kindex set shell
10962 @item set shell
10963 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
10964 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
10965
10966 @kindex show shell
10967 @item show shell
10968 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
10969
10970 @end table
10971
10972 @node Embedded OS
10973 @section Embedded Operating Systems
10974
10975 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10976 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10977 architectures.
10978
10979 @menu
10980 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10981 @end menu
10982
10983 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10984 various real-time operating systems.
10985
10986 @node VxWorks
10987 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10988
10989 @cindex VxWorks
10990
10991 @table @code
10992
10993 @kindex target vxworks
10994 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10995 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10996 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10997
10998 @end table
10999
11000 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11001 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11002
11003 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11004 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11005 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11006 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11007 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11008 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11009 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11010
11011 @table @code
11012 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11013 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11014 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11015 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11016 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11017 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11018 of a thin network line.
11019 @end table
11020
11021 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11022 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11023 procedures.
11024
11025 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11026 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11027 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11028 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11029 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11030 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11031 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11032 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11033 manual.
11034 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11035
11036 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11037 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11038 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11039 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11040
11041 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 (vxgdb)
11045 @end smallexample
11046
11047 @menu
11048 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11049 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11050 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11051 @end menu
11052
11053 @node VxWorks Connection
11054 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11055
11056 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11057 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11058
11059 @smallexample
11060 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11061 @end smallexample
11062
11063 @need 750
11064 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11065
11066 @smallexample
11067 Attaching remote machine across net...
11068 Connected to tt.
11069 @end smallexample
11070
11071 @need 1000
11072 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11073 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11074 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11075 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11076 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11077
11078 @smallexample
11079 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11080 @end smallexample
11081
11082 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11083 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11084 command again.
11085
11086 @node VxWorks Download
11087 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11088
11089 @cindex download to VxWorks
11090 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11091 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11092 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11093 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11094 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11095 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11096 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11097 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11098 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11099 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11100 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11101 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11102 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11103 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11104 program, type this on VxWorks:
11105
11106 @smallexample
11107 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11108 @end smallexample
11109
11110 @noindent
11111 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11112
11113 @smallexample
11114 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11115 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11116 @end smallexample
11117
11118 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11119
11120 @smallexample
11121 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11122 @end smallexample
11123
11124 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11125 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11126 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11127 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11128 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11129 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11130 table.)
11131
11132 @node VxWorks Attach
11133 @subsubsection Running tasks
11134
11135 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11136 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11137 follows:
11138
11139 @smallexample
11140 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11141 @end smallexample
11142
11143 @noindent
11144 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11145 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11146 the time of attachment.
11147
11148 @node Embedded Processors
11149 @section Embedded Processors
11150
11151 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11152 configurations.
11153
11154
11155 @menu
11156 * ARM:: ARM
11157 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11158 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11159 * i960:: Intel i960
11160 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11161 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11162 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11163 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
11164 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11165 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11166 * SH:: Hitachi SH
11167 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11168 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11169 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11170 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11171 @end menu
11172
11173 @node ARM
11174 @subsection ARM
11175
11176 @table @code
11177
11178 @kindex target rdi
11179 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11180 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11181 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11182 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11183
11184 @kindex target rdp
11185 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11186 ARM Demon monitor.
11187
11188 @end table
11189
11190 @node H8/300
11191 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11192
11193 @table @code
11194
11195 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11196 @item target hms @var{dev}
11197 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11198 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11199 line and the communications speed used.
11200
11201 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11202 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11203 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11204
11205 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11206 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11207 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11208 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11209 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11210
11211 @end table
11212
11213 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11214 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11215 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11216 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11217 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11218 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11219 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11220 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11221
11222 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11223 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11224
11225 @enumerate
11226 @item
11227 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11228 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11229 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11230 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11231 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11232
11233 @item
11234 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11235 serial device available on your host is the default).
11236
11237 @item
11238 what speed to use over the serial device.
11239 @end enumerate
11240
11241 @menu
11242 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11243 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11244 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11245 @end menu
11246
11247 @node Hitachi Boards
11248 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11249
11250 @c only for Unix hosts
11251 @kindex device
11252 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11253 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11254 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11255 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11256 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11257
11258 @kindex speed
11259 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11260 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11261 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11262 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11263 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11264 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11265
11266 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11267 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11268 use a DOS host,
11269 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11270 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11271 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11272 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11273
11274 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11275 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11276 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11277 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11278
11279 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11280 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11281 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11282 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11283 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11284 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11285 @code{COM2}.
11286
11287 @smallexample
11288 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11289 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11290
11291 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11292
11293 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11294
11295 @end smallexample
11296
11297 @quotation
11298 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11299 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11300 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11301 your development board.
11302 @end quotation
11303
11304 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11305 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11306 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11307 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11308 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11309 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11310 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11311 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11312 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11313 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11314 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11315 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11316 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11317
11318 @smallexample
11319 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11320 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11321 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11322 the conditions.
11323 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11324 for details.
11325 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11326 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11327 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11328 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11329 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11330 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11331 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11332 @end smallexample
11333
11334 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11335 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11336 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11337 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11338 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11339 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11340
11341 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11342 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11343 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11344
11345 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11346 @itemize @bullet
11347 @item
11348 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11349 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11350
11351 @item
11352 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11353 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11354 to detect program completion.
11355 @end itemize
11356
11357 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11358 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11359
11360 @node Hitachi ICE
11361 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11362
11363 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11364 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11365 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11366 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11367
11368 @table @code
11369 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11370 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11371 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11372 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11373 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11374
11375 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11376 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11377 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11378 @end table
11379
11380 @node Hitachi Special
11381 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11382
11383 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11384
11385 @table @code
11386
11387 @kindex set machine
11388 @kindex show machine
11389 @item set machine h8300
11390 @itemx set machine h8300h
11391 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11392 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11393 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11394
11395 @end table
11396
11397 @node H8/500
11398 @subsection H8/500
11399
11400 @table @code
11401
11402 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
11403 @cindex memory models, H8/500
11404 @item set memory @var{mod}
11405 @itemx show memory
11406 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11407 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11408 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11409 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11410
11411 @end table
11412
11413 @node i960
11414 @subsection Intel i960
11415
11416 @table @code
11417
11418 @kindex target mon960
11419 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
11420 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11421
11422 @kindex target nindy
11423 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
11424 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11425 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11426 @file{/dev/ttya}.
11427
11428 @end table
11429
11430 @cindex Nindy
11431 @cindex i960
11432 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11433 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11434 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11435
11436 @itemize @bullet
11437 @item
11438 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11439 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11440
11441 @item
11442 By responding to a prompt on startup;
11443
11444 @item
11445 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11446 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11447
11448 @end itemize
11449
11450 @cindex download to Nindy-960
11451 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11452 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11453 @value{GDBN}.
11454
11455 @menu
11456 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11457 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11458 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11459 @end menu
11460
11461 @node Nindy Startup
11462 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11463
11464 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11465 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11466 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11467
11468 @smallexample
11469 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11470 @end smallexample
11471
11472 @noindent
11473 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11474 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11475 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11476 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11477 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11478
11479 @node Nindy Options
11480 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
11481
11482 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11483 Nindy-960 board attached:
11484
11485 @table @code
11486 @item -r @var{port}
11487 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11488 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11489 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11490 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11491 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11492 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11493
11494 @item -O
11495 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11496 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11497 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11498 target architecture.
11499
11500 @quotation
11501 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11502 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11503 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11504 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11505 this process with an interrupt.
11506 @end quotation
11507
11508 @item -brk
11509 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11510 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11511
11512 @quotation
11513 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11514 requires; it only works with a few boards.
11515 @end quotation
11516 @end table
11517
11518 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11519 port.
11520
11521 @c @group
11522 @node Nindy Reset
11523 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
11524
11525 @table @code
11526 @item reset
11527 @kindex reset
11528 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11529 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11530 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11531 a break is detected.
11532 @end table
11533 @c @end group
11534
11535 @node M32R/D
11536 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11537
11538 @table @code
11539
11540 @kindex target m32r
11541 @item target m32r @var{dev}
11542 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11543
11544 @end table
11545
11546 @node M68K
11547 @subsection M68k
11548
11549 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11550 target command for the following ROM monitors.
11551
11552 @table @code
11553
11554 @kindex target abug
11555 @item target abug @var{dev}
11556 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11557
11558 @kindex target cpu32bug
11559 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11560 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11561
11562 @kindex target dbug
11563 @item target dbug @var{dev}
11564 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11565
11566 @kindex target est
11567 @item target est @var{dev}
11568 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11569
11570 @kindex target rom68k
11571 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
11572 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11573
11574 @end table
11575
11576 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11577 instead have only a single special target command:
11578
11579 @table @code
11580
11581 @kindex target es1800
11582 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
11583 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11584
11585 @end table
11586
11587 [context?]
11588
11589 @table @code
11590
11591 @kindex target rombug
11592 @item target rombug @var{dev}
11593 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11594
11595 @end table
11596
11597 @node MIPS Embedded
11598 @subsection MIPS Embedded
11599
11600 @cindex MIPS boards
11601 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11602 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11603 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11604
11605 @need 1000
11606 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11607
11608 @table @code
11609 @item target mips @var{port}
11610 @kindex target mips @var{port}
11611 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11612 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11613 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11614 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11615 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11616 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11617
11618 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11619 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11620 debugger:
11621
11622 @smallexample
11623 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11624 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11625 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11626 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11627 (@value{GDBP}) run
11628 @end smallexample
11629
11630 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11631 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11632 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11633 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11634 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11635
11636 @item target pmon @var{port}
11637 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
11638 PMON ROM monitor.
11639
11640 @item target ddb @var{port}
11641 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
11642 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11643
11644 @item target lsi @var{port}
11645 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
11646 LSI variant of PMON.
11647
11648 @kindex target r3900
11649 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
11650 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11651
11652 @kindex target array
11653 @item target array @var{dev}
11654 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11655
11656 @end table
11657
11658
11659 @noindent
11660 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11661
11662 @table @code
11663 @item set processor @var{args}
11664 @itemx show processor
11665 @kindex set processor @var{args}
11666 @kindex show processor
11667 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11668 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11669 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11670 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11671 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11672 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11673 @value{GDBN} is using.
11674
11675 @item set mipsfpu double
11676 @itemx set mipsfpu single
11677 @itemx set mipsfpu none
11678 @itemx show mipsfpu
11679 @kindex set mipsfpu
11680 @kindex show mipsfpu
11681 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
11682 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11683 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11684 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11685 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11686 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11687 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11688 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11689 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11690 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11691 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11692 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11693 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11694
11695 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11696 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11697 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11698
11699 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11700 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
11701
11702 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
11703 @itemx show remotedebug
11704 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11705 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11706 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11707 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11708 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11709 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11710 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11711 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11712 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11713 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11714 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11715
11716 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
11717 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11718 @itemx show timeout
11719 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
11720 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11721 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11722 @kindex set timeout
11723 @kindex show timeout
11724 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
11725 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
11726 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11727 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11728 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11729 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11730 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11731 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11732 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11733 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11734
11735 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11736 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11737 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11738 to run before stopping.
11739 @end table
11740
11741 @node OpenRISC 1000
11742 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
11743 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
11744
11745 @cindex or1k boards
11746 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11747 about platform and commands.
11748
11749 @table @code
11750
11751 @kindex target jtag
11752 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11753
11754 Connects to remote JTAG server.
11755 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11756 connected via parallel port to the board.
11757
11758 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11759
11760 @kindex or1ksim
11761 @item or1ksim @var{command}
11762 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11763 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11764
11765 @kindex info or1k spr
11766 @item info or1k spr
11767 Displays spr groups.
11768
11769 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
11770 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11771 Displays register names in selected group.
11772
11773 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11774 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11775 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11776 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11777 Shows information about specified spr register.
11778
11779 @kindex spr
11780 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11781 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11782 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11783 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11784 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11785 @end table
11786
11787 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11788 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11789 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11790 triggers can be set using:
11791 @table @code
11792 @item $LEA/$LDATA
11793 Load effective address/data
11794 @item $SEA/$SDATA
11795 Store effective address/data
11796 @item $AEA/$ADATA
11797 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11798 @item $FETCH
11799 Fetch data
11800 @end table
11801
11802 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11803 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11804
11805 @code{htrace} commands:
11806 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11807 @table @code
11808 @kindex hwatch
11809 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
11810 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11811 or Data. For example:
11812
11813 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11814
11815 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11816
11817 @kindex htrace info
11818 @item htrace info
11819 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11820
11821 @kindex htrace trigger
11822 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11823 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11824
11825 @kindex htrace qualifier
11826 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11827 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11828
11829 @kindex htrace stop
11830 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11831 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11832
11833 @kindex htrace record
11834 @item htrace record @var{[data]*}
11835 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11836 triggered.
11837
11838 @kindex htrace enable
11839 @item htrace enable
11840 @kindex htrace disable
11841 @itemx htrace disable
11842 Enables/disables the HW trace.
11843
11844 @kindex htrace rewind
11845 @item htrace rewind @var{[filename]}
11846 Clears currently recorded trace data.
11847
11848 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11849 will be written there.
11850
11851 @kindex htrace print
11852 @item htrace print @var{[start [len]]}
11853 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11854
11855 @kindex htrace mode continuous
11856 @item htrace mode continuous
11857 Set continuous trace mode.
11858
11859 @kindex htrace mode suspend
11860 @item htrace mode suspend
11861 Set suspend trace mode.
11862
11863 @end table
11864
11865 @node PowerPC
11866 @subsection PowerPC
11867
11868 @table @code
11869
11870 @kindex target dink32
11871 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
11872 DINK32 ROM monitor.
11873
11874 @kindex target ppcbug
11875 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11876 @kindex target ppcbug1
11877 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11878 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11879
11880 @kindex target sds
11881 @item target sds @var{dev}
11882 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11883
11884 @end table
11885
11886 @node PA
11887 @subsection HP PA Embedded
11888
11889 @table @code
11890
11891 @kindex target op50n
11892 @item target op50n @var{dev}
11893 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11894
11895 @kindex target w89k
11896 @item target w89k @var{dev}
11897 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11898
11899 @end table
11900
11901 @node SH
11902 @subsection Hitachi SH
11903
11904 @table @code
11905
11906 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11907 @item target hms @var{dev}
11908 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11909 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11910 the communications speed used.
11911
11912 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11913 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11914 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11915
11916 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11917 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11918 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11919 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
11920 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11921
11922 @end table
11923
11924 @node Sparclet
11925 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11926
11927 @cindex Sparclet
11928
11929 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11930 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11931 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11932 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11933 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11934
11935 @table @code
11936 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
11937 @kindex remotetimeout
11938 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11939 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11940 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11941 @end table
11942
11943 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11944 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11945 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11946 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11947 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
11948
11949 @smallexample
11950 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11951 @end smallexample
11952
11953 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11954
11955 @smallexample
11956 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11957 @end smallexample
11958
11959 @cindex running, on Sparclet
11960 Once you have set
11961 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11962 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11963 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11964
11965 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11966
11967 @smallexample
11968 (gdbslet)
11969 @end smallexample
11970
11971 @menu
11972 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11973 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11974 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11975 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
11976 @end menu
11977
11978 @node Sparclet File
11979 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
11980
11981 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11982
11983 @smallexample
11984 (gdbslet) file prog
11985 @end smallexample
11986
11987 @need 1000
11988 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11989 @value{GDBN} locates
11990 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11991 path.
11992 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11993 files will be searched as well.
11994 @value{GDBN} locates
11995 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11996 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11997 If it fails
11998 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11999
12000 @smallexample
12001 prog: No such file or directory.
12002 @end smallexample
12003
12004 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12005 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12006 @code{target} command again.
12007
12008 @node Sparclet Connection
12009 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12010
12011 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12012 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12013
12014 @smallexample
12015 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12016 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12017 main () at ../prog.c:3
12018 @end smallexample
12019
12020 @need 750
12021 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12022
12023 @smallexample
12024 Connected to ttya.
12025 @end smallexample
12026
12027 @node Sparclet Download
12028 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12029
12030 @cindex download to Sparclet
12031 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12032 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12033 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12034 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12035 command.
12036 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12037 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12038 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12039 of each of the file's sections.
12040 For instance, if the program
12041 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12042 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12043
12044 @smallexample
12045 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12046 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12047 @end smallexample
12048
12049 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12050 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12051 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12052
12053 @node Sparclet Execution
12054 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12055
12056 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12057 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12058 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12059 manual for the list of commands.
12060
12061 @smallexample
12062 (gdbslet) b main
12063 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12064 (gdbslet) run
12065 Starting program: prog
12066 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12067 3 char *symarg = 0;
12068 (gdbslet) step
12069 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12070 (gdbslet)
12071 @end smallexample
12072
12073 @node Sparclite
12074 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12075
12076 @table @code
12077
12078 @kindex target sparclite
12079 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12080 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12081 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12082 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12083 remote protocol.
12084
12085 @end table
12086
12087 @node ST2000
12088 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12089
12090 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12091 STDBUG protocol.
12092
12093 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12094 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12098 @end smallexample
12099
12100 @noindent
12101 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12102 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12103 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12104 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12105 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12106
12107 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12108 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12109 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12110 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12111 available on your host computer.
12112 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12113 @c basically hearsay.
12114
12115 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12116 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12117 environment:
12118
12119 @table @code
12120 @item st2000 @var{command}
12121 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12122 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12123 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12124 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12125 manual for available commands.
12126
12127 @item connect
12128 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12129 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12130 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12131 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12132 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12133 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12134 @end table
12135
12136 @node Z8000
12137 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12138
12139 @cindex Z8000
12140 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12141 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12142
12143 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12144 a Z8000 simulator.
12145
12146 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12147 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12148 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12149 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12150
12151 @table @code
12152 @item target sim @var{args}
12153 @kindex sim
12154 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12155 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12156 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12157 @end table
12158
12159 @noindent
12160 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12161 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12162 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12163 to run your program, and so on.
12164
12165 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12166 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12167 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12168
12169 @table @code
12170
12171 @item cycles
12172 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12173
12174 @item insts
12175 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12176
12177 @item time
12178 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12179
12180 @end table
12181
12182 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12183 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12184 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12185 simulated clock ticks.
12186
12187 @node Architectures
12188 @section Architectures
12189
12190 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12191 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12192
12193 @menu
12194 * A29K::
12195 * Alpha::
12196 * MIPS::
12197 @end menu
12198
12199 @node A29K
12200 @subsection A29K
12201
12202 @table @code
12203
12204 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12205 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12206 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12207 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12208 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12209 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12210 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12211 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12212 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12213 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12214 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12215 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12216 hexadecimal.
12217
12218 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12219 @item show rstack_high_address
12220 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12221 processors.
12222
12223 @end table
12224
12225 @node Alpha
12226 @subsection Alpha
12227
12228 See the following section.
12229
12230 @node MIPS
12231 @subsection MIPS
12232
12233 @cindex stack on Alpha
12234 @cindex stack on MIPS
12235 @cindex Alpha stack
12236 @cindex MIPS stack
12237 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12238 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12239 find the beginning of a function.
12240
12241 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12242 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12243 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12244 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12245 commands:
12246
12247 @table @code
12248 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12249 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12250 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12251 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12252 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12253 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12254 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12255
12256 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12257 Display the current limit.
12258 @end table
12259
12260 @noindent
12261 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12262 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12263
12264
12265 @node Controlling GDB
12266 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12267
12268 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12269 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12270 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12271 described here.
12272
12273 @menu
12274 * Prompt:: Prompt
12275 * Editing:: Command editing
12276 * History:: Command history
12277 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12278 * Numbers:: Numbers
12279 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
12280 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12281 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12282 @end menu
12283
12284 @node Prompt
12285 @section Prompt
12286
12287 @cindex prompt
12288
12289 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12290 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12291 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12292 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12293 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12294 which one you are talking to.
12295
12296 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12297 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12298 or a prompt that does not.
12299
12300 @table @code
12301 @kindex set prompt
12302 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12303 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12304
12305 @kindex show prompt
12306 @item show prompt
12307 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12308 @end table
12309
12310 @node Editing
12311 @section Command editing
12312 @cindex readline
12313 @cindex command line editing
12314
12315 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12316 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12317 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12318 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12319 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12320 debugging sessions.
12321
12322 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12323 command @code{set}.
12324
12325 @table @code
12326 @kindex set editing
12327 @cindex editing
12328 @item set editing
12329 @itemx set editing on
12330 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12331
12332 @item set editing off
12333 Disable command line editing.
12334
12335 @kindex show editing
12336 @item show editing
12337 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12338 @end table
12339
12340 @node History
12341 @section Command history
12342
12343 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12344 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12345 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12346 history facility.
12347
12348 @table @code
12349 @cindex history substitution
12350 @cindex history file
12351 @kindex set history filename
12352 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12353 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12354 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12355 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12356 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12357 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12358 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12359 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12360 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12361 is not set.
12362
12363 @cindex history save
12364 @kindex set history save
12365 @item set history save
12366 @itemx set history save on
12367 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12368 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12369
12370 @item set history save off
12371 Stop recording command history in a file.
12372
12373 @cindex history size
12374 @kindex set history size
12375 @item set history size @var{size}
12376 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12377 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12378 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12379 @end table
12380
12381 @cindex history expansion
12382 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12383 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12384 @xref{Event Designators}.
12385 @end ifset
12386
12387 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12388 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12389 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12390 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12391 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12392 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12393 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12394
12395 The commands to control history expansion are:
12396
12397 @table @code
12398 @kindex set history expansion
12399 @item set history expansion on
12400 @itemx set history expansion
12401 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12402
12403 @item set history expansion off
12404 Disable history expansion.
12405
12406 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12407 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12408 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12409 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12410 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12411 @end ifset
12412
12413 @c @group
12414 @kindex show history
12415 @item show history
12416 @itemx show history filename
12417 @itemx show history save
12418 @itemx show history size
12419 @itemx show history expansion
12420 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12421 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12422 @c @end group
12423 @end table
12424
12425 @table @code
12426 @kindex shows
12427 @item show commands
12428 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12429
12430 @item show commands @var{n}
12431 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12432
12433 @item show commands +
12434 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12435 @end table
12436
12437 @node Screen Size
12438 @section Screen size
12439 @cindex size of screen
12440 @cindex pauses in output
12441
12442 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12443 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12444 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12445 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12446 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12447 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12448 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12449 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12450
12451 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12452 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12453 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12454 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12455 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12456 width} commands:
12457
12458 @table @code
12459 @kindex set height
12460 @kindex set width
12461 @kindex show width
12462 @kindex show height
12463 @item set height @var{lpp}
12464 @itemx show height
12465 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12466 @itemx show width
12467 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12468 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12469 commands display the current settings.
12470
12471 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12472 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12473 file or to an editor buffer.
12474
12475 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12476 from wrapping its output.
12477 @end table
12478
12479 @node Numbers
12480 @section Numbers
12481 @cindex number representation
12482 @cindex entering numbers
12483
12484 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12485 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12486 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12487 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12488 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12489 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12490 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12491 radix} command.
12492
12493 @table @code
12494 @kindex set input-radix
12495 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12496 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12497 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12498 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12499 example, any of
12500
12501 @smallexample
12502 set radix 012
12503 set radix 10.
12504 set radix 0xa
12505 @end smallexample
12506
12507 @noindent
12508 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12509 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12510
12511 @kindex set output-radix
12512 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12513 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12514 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12515 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12516
12517 @kindex show input-radix
12518 @item show input-radix
12519 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12520
12521 @kindex show output-radix
12522 @item show output-radix
12523 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12524 @end table
12525
12526 @node ABI
12527 @section Configuring the current ABI
12528
12529 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12530 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12531 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12532 current ABI.
12533
12534 @cindex OS ABI
12535 @kindex set osabi
12536
12537 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12538 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12539 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12540 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12541 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12542 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12543 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12544 platform provides.
12545
12546 @table @code
12547 @item show osabi
12548 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12549
12550 @item set osabi
12551 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12552
12553 @item set osabi @var{abi}
12554 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12555 @end table
12556
12557 @cindex float promotion
12558 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12559
12560 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12561 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12562 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12563 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12564 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12565 @code{double} and then passed.
12566
12567 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12568 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12569 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12570
12571 @table @code
12572 @item set coerce-float-to-double
12573 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12574 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12575 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12576
12577 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
12578 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12579 functions.
12580 @end table
12581
12582 @node Messages/Warnings
12583 @section Optional warnings and messages
12584
12585 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12586 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12587 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12588 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12589
12590 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12591 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12592 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12593
12594 @table @code
12595 @kindex set verbose
12596 @item set verbose on
12597 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12598
12599 @item set verbose off
12600 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12601
12602 @kindex show verbose
12603 @item show verbose
12604 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12605 @end table
12606
12607 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12608 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12609 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12610 symbol files}).
12611
12612 @table @code
12613
12614 @kindex set complaints
12615 @item set complaints @var{limit}
12616 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12617 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12618 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12619 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12620
12621 @kindex show complaints
12622 @item show complaints
12623 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12624
12625 @end table
12626
12627 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12628 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12629 you try to run a program which is already running:
12630
12631 @smallexample
12632 (@value{GDBP}) run
12633 The program being debugged has been started already.
12634 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12635 @end smallexample
12636
12637 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12638 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12639
12640 @table @code
12641
12642 @kindex set confirm
12643 @cindex flinching
12644 @cindex confirmation
12645 @cindex stupid questions
12646 @item set confirm off
12647 Disables confirmation requests.
12648
12649 @item set confirm on
12650 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12651
12652 @kindex show confirm
12653 @item show confirm
12654 Displays state of confirmation requests.
12655
12656 @end table
12657
12658 @node Debugging Output
12659 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
12660 @table @code
12661 @kindex set debug arch
12662 @item set debug arch
12663 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12664 @kindex show debug arch
12665 @item show debug arch
12666 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12667 @kindex set debug event
12668 @item set debug event
12669 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12670 default is off.
12671 @kindex show debug event
12672 @item show debug event
12673 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12674 info.
12675 @kindex set debug expression
12676 @item set debug expression
12677 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12678 default is off.
12679 @kindex show debug expression
12680 @item show debug expression
12681 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12682 debugging info.
12683 @kindex set debug overload
12684 @item set debug overload
12685 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12686 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12687 is off.
12688 @kindex show debug overload
12689 @item show debug overload
12690 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12691 debugging info.
12692 @kindex set debug remote
12693 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12694 @cindex serial connections, debugging
12695 @item set debug remote
12696 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12697 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12698 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12699 @kindex show debug remote
12700 @item show debug remote
12701 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12702 @kindex set debug serial
12703 @item set debug serial
12704 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12705 default is off.
12706 @kindex show debug serial
12707 @item show debug serial
12708 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12709 info.
12710 @kindex set debug target
12711 @item set debug target
12712 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12713 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12714 default is off.
12715 @kindex show debug target
12716 @item show debug target
12717 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12718 info.
12719 @kindex set debug varobj
12720 @item set debug varobj
12721 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12722 info. The default is off.
12723 @kindex show debug varobj
12724 @item show debug varobj
12725 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12726 debugging info.
12727 @end table
12728
12729 @node Sequences
12730 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12731
12732 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12733 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12734 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12735 files.
12736
12737 @menu
12738 * Define:: User-defined commands
12739 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12740 * Command Files:: Command files
12741 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
12742 @end menu
12743
12744 @node Define
12745 @section User-defined commands
12746
12747 @cindex user-defined command
12748 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12749 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12750 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12751 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12752 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
12753
12754 @smallexample
12755 define adder
12756 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12757 @end smallexample
12758
12759 @noindent
12760 To execute the command use:
12761
12762 @smallexample
12763 adder 1 2 3
12764 @end smallexample
12765
12766 @noindent
12767 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12768 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12769 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12770 functions calls.
12771
12772 @table @code
12773
12774 @kindex define
12775 @item define @var{commandname}
12776 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12777 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12778
12779 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12780 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12781 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12782
12783 @kindex if
12784 @kindex else
12785 @item if
12786 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12787 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12788 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12789 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12790 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12791 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12792
12793 @kindex while
12794 @item while
12795 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12796 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12797 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12798 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12799 evaluates to true.
12800
12801 @kindex document
12802 @item document @var{commandname}
12803 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12804 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12805 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12806 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12807 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12808 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12809
12810 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12811 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12812 does not change the documentation.
12813
12814 @kindex help user-defined
12815 @item help user-defined
12816 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12817 (if any) for each.
12818
12819 @kindex show user
12820 @item show user
12821 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
12822 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12823 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12824 definitions for all user-defined commands.
12825
12826 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
12827 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
12828 @item show max-user-call-depth
12829 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
12830 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12831 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12832 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
12833
12834 @end table
12835
12836 When user-defined commands are executed, the
12837 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12838 stops execution of the user-defined command.
12839
12840 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12841 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12842 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12843 messages when used in a user-defined command.
12844
12845 @node Hooks
12846 @section User-defined command hooks
12847 @cindex command hooks
12848 @cindex hooks, for commands
12849 @cindex hooks, pre-command
12850
12851 @kindex hook
12852 @kindex hook-
12853 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12854 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12855 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12856 before that command.
12857
12858 @cindex hooks, post-command
12859 @kindex hookpost
12860 @kindex hookpost-
12861 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12862 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12863 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12864 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12865 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12866
12867 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12868 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12869
12870 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12871 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12872
12873 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12874 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12875 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12876 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12877 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12878
12879 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12880 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12881 you could define:
12882
12883 @smallexample
12884 define hook-stop
12885 handle SIGALRM nopass
12886 end
12887
12888 define hook-run
12889 handle SIGALRM pass
12890 end
12891
12892 define hook-continue
12893 handle SIGLARM pass
12894 end
12895 @end smallexample
12896
12897 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12898 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12899 you could define:
12900
12901 @smallexample
12902 define hook-echo
12903 echo <<<---
12904 end
12905
12906 define hookpost-echo
12907 echo --->>>\n
12908 end
12909
12910 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12911 <<<---Hello World--->>>
12912 (@value{GDBP})
12913
12914 @end smallexample
12915
12916 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12917 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12918 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12919 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12920 @c or not?
12921 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12922 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12923 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12924
12925 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12926 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12927
12928 @node Command Files
12929 @section Command files
12930
12931 @cindex command files
12932 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12933 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12934 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12935 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12936
12937 @cindex init file
12938 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12939 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12940 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12941 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12942 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12943 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12944 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
12945
12946 @enumerate
12947 @item
12948 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12949 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12950 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12951
12952 @item
12953 Processes command line options and operands.
12954
12955 @item
12956 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12957
12958 @item
12959 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12960 @end enumerate
12961
12962 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12963 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12964 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12965 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
12966
12967 @cindex init file name
12968 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12969 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12970 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12971 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12972 environments with special init file names:
12973
12974 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12975 @itemize @bullet
12976 @item
12977 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12978
12979 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12980 @item
12981 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12982
12983 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12984 @item
12985 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12986 @end itemize
12987
12988 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12989 @code{source} command:
12990
12991 @table @code
12992 @kindex source
12993 @item source @var{filename}
12994 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12995 @end table
12996
12997 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12998 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
12999 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13000
13001 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13002 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13003 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13004 when called from command files.
13005
13006 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13007 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13008 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13009 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13010 the next command.
13011
13012 @smallexample
13013 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13014 @end smallexample
13015
13016 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13017 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13018 would be directed to @file{log}.
13019
13020 @node Output
13021 @section Commands for controlled output
13022
13023 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13024 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13025 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13026 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13027 want.
13028
13029 @table @code
13030 @kindex echo
13031 @item echo @var{text}
13032 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13033 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13034 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13035 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13036 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13037 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13038 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13039 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13040 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13041 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13042 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13043
13044 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13045 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13046
13047 @smallexample
13048 echo This is some text\n\
13049 which is continued\n\
13050 onto several lines.\n
13051 @end smallexample
13052
13053 produces the same output as
13054
13055 @smallexample
13056 echo This is some text\n
13057 echo which is continued\n
13058 echo onto several lines.\n
13059 @end smallexample
13060
13061 @kindex output
13062 @item output @var{expression}
13063 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13064 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13065 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13066 on expressions.
13067
13068 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13069 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13070 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13071 formats}, for more information.
13072
13073 @kindex printf
13074 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13075 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13076 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13077 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13078 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13079 subroutine
13080 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13081 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13082 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13083 @c supported.
13084
13085 @smallexample
13086 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13087 @end smallexample
13088
13089 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13090
13091 @smallexample
13092 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13093 @end smallexample
13094
13095 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13096 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13097 letter.
13098 @end table
13099
13100 @node TUI
13101 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13102 @cindex TUI
13103
13104 @menu
13105 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13106 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13107 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13108 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13109 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13110 @end menu
13111
13112 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13113 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13114 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13115 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13116 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13117 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13118
13119 @node TUI Overview
13120 @section TUI overview
13121
13122 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13123 @value{GDBN} runs:
13124
13125 @itemize @bullet
13126 @item
13127 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13128 windows on the terminal.
13129
13130 @item
13131 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13132 the TUI.
13133 @end itemize
13134
13135 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13136 on the terminal:
13137
13138 @table @emph
13139 @item command
13140 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13141 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13142 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13143 window is always visible.
13144
13145 @item source
13146 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13147 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13148
13149 @item assembly
13150 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13151
13152 @item register
13153 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13154 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13155 changed are highlighted.
13156
13157 @end table
13158
13159 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13160 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13161 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13162 indicates the breakpoint type:
13163
13164 @table @code
13165 @item B
13166 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13167
13168 @item b
13169 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13170
13171 @item H
13172 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13173
13174 @item h
13175 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13176
13177 @end table
13178
13179 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13180
13181 @table @code
13182 @item +
13183 Breakpoint is enabled.
13184
13185 @item -
13186 Breakpoint is disabled.
13187
13188 @end table
13189
13190 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13191 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13192 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13193 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13194 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13195 The following layouts are available:
13196
13197 @itemize @bullet
13198 @item
13199 source
13200
13201 @item
13202 assembly
13203
13204 @item
13205 source and assembly
13206
13207 @item
13208 source and registers
13209
13210 @item
13211 assembly and registers
13212
13213 @end itemize
13214
13215 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13216 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13217 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13218 are displayed:
13219
13220 @table @emph
13221 @item target
13222 Indicates the current gdb target
13223 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13224
13225 @item process
13226 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13227 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13228
13229 @item function
13230 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13231 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13232 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13233 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13234
13235 @item line
13236 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13237 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13238
13239 @item pc
13240 Indicates the current program counter address.
13241
13242 @end table
13243
13244 @node TUI Keys
13245 @section TUI Key Bindings
13246 @cindex TUI key bindings
13247
13248 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13249 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13250 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13251 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13252 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13253 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13254 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13255
13256 @table @kbd
13257 @kindex C-x C-a
13258 @item C-x C-a
13259 @kindex C-x a
13260 @itemx C-x a
13261 @kindex C-x A
13262 @itemx C-x A
13263 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13264 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13265 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13266 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13267 The screen is then refreshed.
13268
13269 @kindex C-x 1
13270 @item C-x 1
13271 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13272 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13273 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13274
13275 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13276
13277 @kindex C-x 2
13278 @item C-x 2
13279 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13280 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13281 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13282 previous layout and the new one.
13283
13284 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13285
13286 @kindex C-x s
13287 @item C-x s
13288 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13289 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13290
13291 @end table
13292
13293 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13294
13295 @table @key
13296 @kindex PgUp
13297 @item PgUp
13298 Scroll the active window one page up.
13299
13300 @kindex PgDn
13301 @item PgDn
13302 Scroll the active window one page down.
13303
13304 @kindex Up
13305 @item Up
13306 Scroll the active window one line up.
13307
13308 @kindex Down
13309 @item Down
13310 Scroll the active window one line down.
13311
13312 @kindex Left
13313 @item Left
13314 Scroll the active window one column left.
13315
13316 @kindex Right
13317 @item Right
13318 Scroll the active window one column right.
13319
13320 @kindex C-L
13321 @item C-L
13322 Refresh the screen.
13323
13324 @end table
13325
13326 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13327 for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13328 necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13329 @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13330
13331 @node TUI Single Key Mode
13332 @section TUI Single Key Mode
13333 @cindex TUI single key mode
13334
13335 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13336 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13337 some gdb commands.
13338
13339 @table @kbd
13340 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13341 @item c
13342 continue
13343
13344 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13345 @item d
13346 down
13347
13348 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13349 @item f
13350 finish
13351
13352 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13353 @item n
13354 next
13355
13356 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13357 @item q
13358 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13359
13360 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13361 @item r
13362 run
13363
13364 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13365 @item s
13366 step
13367
13368 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13369 @item u
13370 up
13371
13372 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13373 @item v
13374 info locals
13375
13376 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13377 @item w
13378 where
13379
13380 @end table
13381
13382 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13383 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13384 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13385 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13386 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13387 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13388
13389
13390 @node TUI Commands
13391 @section TUI specific commands
13392 @cindex TUI commands
13393
13394 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13395 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13396 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13397 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13398 in the TUI mode.
13399
13400 @table @code
13401 @item info win
13402 @kindex info win
13403 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13404
13405 @item layout next
13406 @kindex layout next
13407 Display the next layout.
13408
13409 @item layout prev
13410 @kindex layout prev
13411 Display the previous layout.
13412
13413 @item layout src
13414 @kindex layout src
13415 Display the source window only.
13416
13417 @item layout asm
13418 @kindex layout asm
13419 Display the assembly window only.
13420
13421 @item layout split
13422 @kindex layout split
13423 Display the source and assembly window.
13424
13425 @item layout regs
13426 @kindex layout regs
13427 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13428
13429 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13430 @kindex focus
13431 Set the focus to the named window.
13432 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13433 can be affected to another window.
13434
13435 @item refresh
13436 @kindex refresh
13437 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13438
13439 @item update
13440 @kindex update
13441 Update the source window and the current execution point.
13442
13443 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13444 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13445 @kindex winheight
13446 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13447 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13448 decrease it.
13449
13450 @end table
13451
13452 @node TUI Configuration
13453 @section TUI configuration variables
13454 @cindex TUI configuration variables
13455
13456 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13457 appearance of windows on the terminal.
13458
13459 @table @code
13460 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13461 @kindex set tui border-kind
13462 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13463 The possible values are the following:
13464 @table @code
13465 @item space
13466 Use a space character to draw the border.
13467
13468 @item ascii
13469 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13470
13471 @item acs
13472 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13473 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13474
13475 @end table
13476
13477 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13478 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
13479 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13480 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13481 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13482
13483 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13484 @kindex set tui border-mode
13485 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13486 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13487 @table @code
13488 @item normal
13489 Use normal attributes to display the border.
13490
13491 @item standout
13492 Use standout mode.
13493
13494 @item reverse
13495 Use reverse video mode.
13496
13497 @item half
13498 Use half bright mode.
13499
13500 @item half-standout
13501 Use half bright and standout mode.
13502
13503 @item bold
13504 Use extra bright or bold mode.
13505
13506 @item bold-standout
13507 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13508
13509 @end table
13510
13511 @end table
13512
13513 @node Emacs
13514 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13515
13516 @cindex Emacs
13517 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13518 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13519 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13520 @value{GDBN}.
13521
13522 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13523 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13524 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13525 created Emacs buffer.
13526 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
13527
13528 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13529 things:
13530
13531 @itemize @bullet
13532 @item
13533 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13534 @end itemize
13535
13536 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13537 and output done by the program you are debugging.
13538
13539 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13540 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13541 in this way.
13542
13543 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13544 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13545 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13546 stop.
13547
13548 @itemize @bullet
13549 @item
13550 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13551 @end itemize
13552
13553 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13554 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13555 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13556 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13557 and the source.
13558
13559 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13560 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13561
13562 @quotation
13563 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13564 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13565 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13566 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13567 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13568 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13569 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13570 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13571 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13572 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13573
13574 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13575 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13576 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13577 @end quotation
13578
13579 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13580 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13581 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13582 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13583
13584 @smallexample
13585 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13586 @end smallexample
13587
13588 @noindent
13589 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13590 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13591 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13592
13593 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13594 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13595
13596 @table @kbd
13597 @item C-h m
13598 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13599
13600 @item M-s
13601 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13602 update the display window to show the current file and location.
13603
13604 @item M-n
13605 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13606 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13607 to show the current file and location.
13608
13609 @item M-i
13610 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13611 display window accordingly.
13612
13613 @item M-x gdb-nexti
13614 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13615 display window accordingly.
13616
13617 @item C-c C-f
13618 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13619 @code{finish} command.
13620
13621 @item M-c
13622 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13623 command.
13624
13625 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13626
13627 @item M-u
13628 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13629 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13630 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13631
13632 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13633
13634 @item M-d
13635 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13636 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13637
13638 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13639
13640 @item C-x &
13641 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13642 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13643 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13644 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13645 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13646
13647 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13648 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13649 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13650 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13651 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13652 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13653 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13654 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13655 @end table
13656
13657 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13658 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13659
13660 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13661 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13662 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13663 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13664 frame.
13665
13666 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13667 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13668 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13669 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13670 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13671 to correspond properly with the code.
13672
13673 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13674 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13675 @ignore
13676 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13677 @kindex Epoch
13678 @kindex inspect
13679
13680 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13681 called the @code{epoch}
13682 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13683 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13684 each value is printed in its own window.
13685 @end ignore
13686
13687 @include annotate.texi
13688 @include gdbmi.texinfo
13689
13690 @node GDB Bugs
13691 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13692 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13693 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13694
13695 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13696
13697 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13698 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13699 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13700 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13701
13702 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13703 information that enables us to fix the bug.
13704
13705 @menu
13706 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13707 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13708 @end menu
13709
13710 @node Bug Criteria
13711 @section Have you found a bug?
13712 @cindex bug criteria
13713
13714 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13715
13716 @itemize @bullet
13717 @cindex fatal signal
13718 @cindex debugger crash
13719 @cindex crash of debugger
13720 @item
13721 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13722 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13723
13724 @cindex error on valid input
13725 @item
13726 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13727 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13728 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13729
13730 @cindex invalid input
13731 @item
13732 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13733 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13734 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13735 for traditional practice''.
13736
13737 @item
13738 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13739 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13740 @end itemize
13741
13742 @node Bug Reporting
13743 @section How to report bugs
13744 @cindex bug reports
13745 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13746
13747 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13748 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13749 contact that organization first.
13750
13751 You can find contact information for many support companies and
13752 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13753 distribution.
13754 @c should add a web page ref...
13755
13756 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13757 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13758 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13759 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13760 be used.
13761
13762 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13763 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13764 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13765 @samp{bug-gdb}.
13766
13767 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13768 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13769 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13770 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13771 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13772 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13773 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13774 bug reports to the mailing list.
13775
13776 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13777 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13778 fact or leave it out, state it!
13779
13780 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13781 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13782 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13783 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13784 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13785 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13786 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13787 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13788 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13789
13790 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13791 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13792 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13793 self-contained.
13794
13795 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13796 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13797 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13798 bugs properly.
13799
13800 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13801
13802 @itemize @bullet
13803 @item
13804 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13805 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13806 version}.
13807
13808 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13809 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13810
13811 @item
13812 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13813 version number.
13814
13815 @item
13816 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13817 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
13818
13819 @item
13820 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13821 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13822 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13823 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13824 compilers.
13825
13826 @item
13827 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13828 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13829 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13830 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13831
13832 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13833 and then we might not encounter the bug.
13834
13835 @item
13836 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13837 reproduce the bug.
13838
13839 @item
13840 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13841 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13842
13843 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13844 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13845 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13846 a chance to make a mistake.
13847
13848 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13849 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13850 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13851 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13852 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13853 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13854 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13855 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13856
13857 @item
13858 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13859 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13860 it by context, not by line number.
13861
13862 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13863 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
13864
13865 @end itemize
13866
13867 Here are some things that are not necessary:
13868
13869 @itemize @bullet
13870 @item
13871 A description of the envelope of the bug.
13872
13873 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13874 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13875 changes will not affect it.
13876
13877 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13878 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13879 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13880 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13881
13882 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13883 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13884 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13885 less time, and so on.
13886
13887 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13888 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13889
13890 @item
13891 A patch for the bug.
13892
13893 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13894 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13895 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13896 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13897
13898 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13899 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13900 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13901 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13902
13903 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13904 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13905 help us to understand.
13906
13907 @item
13908 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13909
13910 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13911 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13912 @end itemize
13913
13914 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13915 @c and consists of the two following files:
13916 @c rluser.texinfo
13917 @c inc-hist.texinfo
13918 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13919 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13920 @include rluser.texinfo
13921 @include inc-hist.texinfo
13922
13923
13924 @node Formatting Documentation
13925 @appendix Formatting Documentation
13926
13927 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13928 @cindex reference card
13929 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13930 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13931 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13932 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13933 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13934 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13935
13936 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13937 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13938
13939 @smallexample
13940 make refcard.dvi
13941 @end smallexample
13942
13943 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13944 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13945 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13946 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13947 your @sc{dvi} output program.
13948
13949 @cindex documentation
13950
13951 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13952 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13953 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13954 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13955 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13956 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13957
13958 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13959 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13960 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13961 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13962 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13963 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13964 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13965 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13966
13967 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13968 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13969 @code{makeinfo}.
13970
13971 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13972 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13973 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13974
13975 @smallexample
13976 cd gdb
13977 make gdb.info
13978 @end smallexample
13979
13980 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13981 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13982 Texinfo definitions file.
13983
13984 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13985 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13986 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13987 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13988 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13989 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13990 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13991
13992 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13993 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13994 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13995 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13996 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13997 directory.
13998
13999 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14000 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14001 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14002 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
14003
14004 @smallexample
14005 make gdb.dvi
14006 @end smallexample
14007
14008 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
14009
14010 @node Installing GDB
14011 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14012 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14013 @cindex installation
14014
14015 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14016 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14017 build the @code{gdb} program.
14018 @iftex
14019 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14020 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14021 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14022 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14023 @end iftex
14024
14025 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14026 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14027 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
14028
14029 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14030 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
14031
14032 @table @code
14033 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14034 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
14035
14036 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14037 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
14038
14039 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14040 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
14041
14042 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14043 @sc{gnu} include files
14044
14045 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14046 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
14047
14048 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14049 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
14050
14051 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14052 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
14053
14054 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14055 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
14056
14057 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14058 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14059 @end table
14060
14061 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14062 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14063 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
14064
14065 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14066 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14067 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14068 argument.
14069
14070 For example:
14071
14072 @smallexample
14073 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14074 ./configure @var{host}
14075 make
14076 @end smallexample
14077
14078 @noindent
14079 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14080 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14081 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14082 correct value by examining your system.)
14083
14084 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14085 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14086 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14087 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
14088
14089 @need 750
14090 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14091 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14092 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
14093
14094 @smallexample
14095 sh configure @var{host}
14096 @end smallexample
14097
14098 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14099 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14100 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14101 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14102 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14103
14104 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14105 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14106 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
14107
14108 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14109 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
14110
14111 @smallexample
14112 @group
14113 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14114 ../configure @var{host}
14115 @end group
14116 @end smallexample
14117
14118 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14119 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14120 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14121 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14122 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
14123
14124 @menu
14125 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14126 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14127 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14128 @end menu
14129
14130 @node Separate Objdir
14131 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14132
14133 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14134 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14135 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14136 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14137 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14138 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14139 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14140 program specified there.
14141
14142 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14143 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14144 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14145 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14146 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14147 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
14148
14149 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14150 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
14151
14152 @smallexample
14153 @group
14154 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14155 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14156 cd ../gdb-sun4
14157 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14158 make
14159 @end group
14160 @end smallexample
14161
14162 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14163 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14164 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14165 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14166 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14167 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
14168
14169 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14170 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14171 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14172 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14173 You specify a cross-debugging target by
14174 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14175
14176 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14177 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14178 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14179
14180 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14181 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14182 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14183 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14184 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14185
14186 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14187 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14188 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14189 with each other.
14190
14191 @node Config Names
14192 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14193
14194 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14195 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14196 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14197 of information in the following pattern:
14198
14199 @smallexample
14200 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14201 @end smallexample
14202
14203 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14204 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14205 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14206
14207 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14208 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14209 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14210 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14211 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14212 abbreviations---for example:
14213
14214 @smallexample
14215 % sh config.sub i386-linux
14216 i386-pc-linux-gnu
14217 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
14218 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14219 % sh config.sub hp9k700
14220 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14221 % sh config.sub sun4
14222 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14223 % sh config.sub sun3
14224 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14225 % sh config.sub i986v
14226 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14227 @end smallexample
14228
14229 @noindent
14230 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14231 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14232
14233 @node Configure Options
14234 @section @code{configure} options
14235
14236 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14237 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14238 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14239 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14240
14241 @smallexample
14242 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14243 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14244 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14245 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14246 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14247 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14248 @var{host}
14249 @end smallexample
14250
14251 @noindent
14252 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14253 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14254 @samp{--}.
14255
14256 @table @code
14257 @item --help
14258 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14259
14260 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
14261 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14262 @file{@var{dir}}.
14263
14264 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14265 Configure the source to install programs under directory
14266 @file{@var{dir}}.
14267
14268 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14269 @need 2000
14270 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14271 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14272 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14273 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14274 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14275 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14276 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14277 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14278 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14279 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14280 @var{dirname}.
14281
14282 @item --norecursion
14283 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14284 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14285
14286 @item --target=@var{target}
14287 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14288 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14289 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14290
14291 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14292
14293 @item @var{host} @dots{}
14294 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14295
14296 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14297 @end table
14298
14299 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14300 needed for special purposes only.
14301
14302 @node Maintenance Commands
14303 @appendix Maintenance Commands
14304 @cindex maintenance commands
14305 @cindex internal commands
14306
14307 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14308 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14309 These commands are provided here for reference.
14310
14311 @table @code
14312 @kindex maint info breakpoints
14313 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14314 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14315 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14316 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14317 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14318 is shown:
14319
14320 @table @code
14321 @item breakpoint
14322 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
14323
14324 @item watchpoint
14325 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
14326
14327 @item longjmp
14328 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14329 @code{longjmp} calls.
14330
14331 @item longjmp resume
14332 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
14333
14334 @item until
14335 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
14336
14337 @item finish
14338 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
14339
14340 @item shlib events
14341 Shared library events.
14342
14343 @end table
14344
14345 @kindex maint internal-error
14346 @kindex maint internal-warning
14347 @item maint internal-error
14348 @itemx maint internal-warning
14349 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14350 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14351 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14352 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14353 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14354 @value{GDBN} session.
14355
14356 @smallexample
14357 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14358 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14359 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14360 debugging may prove unreliable.
14361 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14362 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14363 (gdb)
14364 @end smallexample
14365
14366 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14367 warning message.
14368
14369 @kindex maint print registers
14370 @kindex maint print raw-registers
14371 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
14372 @item maint print registers
14373 @itemx maint print raw-registers
14374 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
14375 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14376
14377 The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14378 the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14379 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14380 @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14381
14382 Takes an optional file parameter.
14383
14384 @end table
14385
14386
14387 @node Remote Protocol
14388 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
14389
14390 @menu
14391 * Overview::
14392 * Packets::
14393 * Stop Reply Packets::
14394 * General Query Packets::
14395 * Register Packet Format::
14396 * Examples::
14397 @end menu
14398
14399 @node Overview
14400 @section Overview
14401
14402 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14403 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14404 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14405 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
14406
14407 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
14408 transmitted and received data respectfully.
14409
14410 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14411 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14412 @cindex remote serial protocol
14413 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14414 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14415 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14416 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
14417
14418 @smallexample
14419 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14420 @end smallexample
14421 @noindent
14422
14423 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14424 @noindent
14425 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14426 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14427 eight bit unsigned checksum).
14428
14429 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14430 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
14431
14432 @smallexample
14433 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14434 @end smallexample
14435
14436 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14437 @noindent
14438 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14439 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14440 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
14441
14442 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14443 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14444 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14445 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14446 retransmission):
14447
14448 @smallexample
14449 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14450 <- @code{+}
14451 @end smallexample
14452 @noindent
14453
14454 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14455 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14456 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14457 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
14458
14459 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14460 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14461 exceptions).
14462
14463 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14464 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
14465 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14466 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
14467
14468 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14469 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14470 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
14471
14472 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14473 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14474 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14475 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14476 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14477 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14478 value greater than 126 should not be used.
14479
14480 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14481 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14482 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
14483
14484 So:
14485 @smallexample
14486 "@code{0* }"
14487 @end smallexample
14488 @noindent
14489 means the same as "0000".
14490
14491 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14492 error number. That number is not well defined.
14493
14494 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14495 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14496 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14497 on that response.
14498
14499 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14500 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14501 optional.
14502
14503 @node Packets
14504 @section Packets
14505
14506 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14507 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14508
14509 @table @r
14510
14511 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
14512 @cindex @code{!} packet
14513
14514 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14515 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14516 debugged.
14517
14518 Reply:
14519 @table @samp
14520 @item OK
14521 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
14522 @end table
14523
14524 @item @code{?} --- last signal
14525 @cindex @code{?} packet
14526
14527 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14528 step and continue.
14529
14530 Reply:
14531 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14532
14533 @item @code{a} --- reserved
14534
14535 Reserved for future use.
14536
14537 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14538 @cindex @code{A} packet
14539
14540 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14541 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14542 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14543
14544 Reply:
14545 @table @samp
14546 @item OK
14547 @item E@var{NN}
14548 @end table
14549
14550 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14551 @cindex @code{b} packet
14552
14553 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14554
14555 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14556 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14557 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14558
14559 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14560 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14561 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14562 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14563 of view, nothing actually happened.}
14564
14565 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14566 @cindex @code{B} packet
14567
14568 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14569 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14570
14571 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14572 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
14573
14574 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14575 @cindex @code{c} packet
14576
14577 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14578 current address.
14579
14580 Reply:
14581 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14582
14583 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14584 @cindex @code{C} packet
14585
14586 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14587 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14588
14589 Reply:
14590 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14591
14592 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14593 @cindex @code{d} packet
14594
14595 Toggle debug flag.
14596
14597 @item @code{D} --- detach
14598 @cindex @code{D} packet
14599
14600 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14601 before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14602
14603 Reply:
14604 @table @samp
14605 @item @emph{no response}
14606 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
14607 @end table
14608
14609 @item @code{e} --- reserved
14610
14611 Reserved for future use.
14612
14613 @item @code{E} --- reserved
14614
14615 Reserved for future use.
14616
14617 @item @code{f} --- reserved
14618
14619 Reserved for future use.
14620
14621 @item @code{F} --- reserved
14622
14623 Reserved for future use.
14624
14625 @item @code{g} --- read registers
14626 @anchor{read registers packet}
14627 @cindex @code{g} packet
14628
14629 Read general registers.
14630
14631 Reply:
14632 @table @samp
14633 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
14634 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14635 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14636 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14637 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14638 and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14639 @code{g} packets is specified below.
14640 @item E@var{NN}
14641 for an error.
14642 @end table
14643
14644 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14645 @cindex @code{G} packet
14646
14647 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14648 data.
14649
14650 Reply:
14651 @table @samp
14652 @item OK
14653 for success
14654 @item E@var{NN}
14655 for an error
14656 @end table
14657
14658 @item @code{h} --- reserved
14659
14660 Reserved for future use.
14661
14662 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14663 @cindex @code{H} packet
14664
14665 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14666 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14667 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14668 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14669 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14670
14671 Reply:
14672 @table @samp
14673 @item OK
14674 for success
14675 @item E@var{NN}
14676 for an error
14677 @end table
14678
14679 @c FIXME: JTC:
14680 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14681 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14682 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14683 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14684 @c described. For example:
14685 @c
14686 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14687 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14688 @c otherwise returns current registers.
14689 @c
14690 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14691 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14692 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
14693
14694 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14695 @anchor{cycle step packet}
14696 @cindex @code{i} packet
14697
14698 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14699 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14700 step starting at that address.
14701
14702 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14703 @cindex @code{I} packet
14704
14705 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14706
14707 @item @code{j} --- reserved
14708
14709 Reserved for future use.
14710
14711 @item @code{J} --- reserved
14712
14713 Reserved for future use.
14714
14715 @item @code{k} --- kill request
14716 @cindex @code{k} packet
14717
14718 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
14719 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14720 thread?)}.
14721
14722 @item @code{K} --- reserved
14723
14724 Reserved for future use.
14725
14726 @item @code{l} --- reserved
14727
14728 Reserved for future use.
14729
14730 @item @code{L} --- reserved
14731
14732 Reserved for future use.
14733
14734 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14735 @cindex @code{m} packet
14736
14737 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14738 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
14739 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
14740 transfer mechanism is needed.}
14741
14742 Reply:
14743 @table @samp
14744 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
14745 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14746 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
14747 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
14748 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14749 needed.}
14750 @item E@var{NN}
14751 @var{NN} is errno
14752 @end table
14753
14754 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14755 @cindex @code{M} packet
14756
14757 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14758 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14759
14760 Reply:
14761 @table @samp
14762 @item OK
14763 for success
14764 @item E@var{NN}
14765 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14766 written).
14767 @end table
14768
14769 @item @code{n} --- reserved
14770
14771 Reserved for future use.
14772
14773 @item @code{N} --- reserved
14774
14775 Reserved for future use.
14776
14777 @item @code{o} --- reserved
14778
14779 Reserved for future use.
14780
14781 @item @code{O} --- reserved
14782
14783 Reserved for future use.
14784
14785 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14786 @cindex @code{p} packet
14787
14788 @xref{write register packet}.
14789
14790 Reply:
14791 @table @samp
14792 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
14793 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14794 @end table
14795
14796 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14797 @anchor{write register packet}
14798 @cindex @code{P} packet
14799
14800 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
14801 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
14802
14803 Reply:
14804 @table @samp
14805 @item OK
14806 for success
14807 @item E@var{NN}
14808 for an error
14809 @end table
14810
14811 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14812 @anchor{general query packet}
14813 @cindex @code{q} packet
14814
14815 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14816 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14817 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14818 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14819 that they match the full @var{query} name.
14820
14821 Reply:
14822 @table @samp
14823 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
14824 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14825 @item E@var{NN}
14826 error reply
14827 @item
14828 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14829 @end table
14830
14831 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14832 @cindex @code{Q} packet
14833
14834 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14835
14836 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
14837
14838 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14839 @cindex @code{r} packet
14840
14841 Reset the entire system.
14842
14843 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
14844 @cindex @code{R} packet
14845
14846 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14847 This packet is only available in extended mode.
14848
14849 Reply:
14850 @table @samp
14851 @item @emph{no reply}
14852 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
14853 @end table
14854
14855 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
14856 @cindex @code{s} packet
14857
14858 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14859 same address.
14860
14861 Reply:
14862 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14863
14864 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
14865 @anchor{step with signal packet}
14866 @cindex @code{S} packet
14867
14868 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
14869
14870 Reply:
14871 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14872
14873 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
14874 @cindex @code{t} packet
14875
14876 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
14877 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
14878 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
14879
14880 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
14881 @cindex @code{T} packet
14882
14883 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
14884
14885 Reply:
14886 @table @samp
14887 @item OK
14888 thread is still alive
14889 @item E@var{NN}
14890 thread is dead
14891 @end table
14892
14893 @item @code{u} --- reserved
14894
14895 Reserved for future use.
14896
14897 @item @code{U} --- reserved
14898
14899 Reserved for future use.
14900
14901 @item @code{v} --- reserved
14902
14903 Reserved for future use.
14904
14905 @item @code{V} --- reserved
14906
14907 Reserved for future use.
14908
14909 @item @code{w} --- reserved
14910
14911 Reserved for future use.
14912
14913 @item @code{W} --- reserved
14914
14915 Reserved for future use.
14916
14917 @item @code{x} --- reserved
14918
14919 Reserved for future use.
14920
14921 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
14922 @cindex @code{X} packet
14923
14924 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
14925 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
14926 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
14927
14928 Reply:
14929 @table @samp
14930 @item OK
14931 for success
14932 @item E@var{NN}
14933 for an error
14934 @end table
14935
14936 @item @code{y} --- reserved
14937
14938 Reserved for future use.
14939
14940 @item @code{Y} reserved
14941
14942 Reserved for future use.
14943
14944 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14945 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14946 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
14947 @cindex @code{z} packet
14948 @cindex @code{Z} packets
14949
14950 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
14951 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
14952 @var{length} bytes.
14953
14954 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
14955 separately.
14956
14957 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
14958 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
14959 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
14960 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
14961 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
14962 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
14963
14964 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14965 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14966 @cindex @code{z0} packet
14967 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
14968
14969 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
14970 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
14971
14972 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
14973 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
14974 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
14975 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
14976 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
14977
14978 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
14979 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
14980 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
14981 target, is not defined.}
14982
14983 Reply:
14984 @table @samp
14985 @item OK
14986 success
14987 @item
14988 not supported
14989 @item E@var{NN}
14990 for an error
14991 @end table
14992
14993 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14994 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14995 @cindex @code{z1} packet
14996 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
14997
14998 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
14999 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15000
15001 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15002 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15003
15004 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15005 movement.}
15006
15007 Reply:
15008 @table @samp
15009 @item OK
15010 success
15011 @item
15012 not supported
15013 @item E@var{NN}
15014 for an error
15015 @end table
15016
15017 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15018 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15019 @cindex @code{z2} packet
15020 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
15021
15022 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15023
15024 Reply:
15025 @table @samp
15026 @item OK
15027 success
15028 @item
15029 not supported
15030 @item E@var{NN}
15031 for an error
15032 @end table
15033
15034 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15035 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15036 @cindex @code{z3} packet
15037 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
15038
15039 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
15040
15041 Reply:
15042 @table @samp
15043 @item OK
15044 success
15045 @item
15046 not supported
15047 @item E@var{NN}
15048 for an error
15049 @end table
15050
15051 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15052 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15053 @cindex @code{z4} packet
15054 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
15055
15056 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15057
15058 Reply:
15059 @table @samp
15060 @item OK
15061 success
15062 @item
15063 not supported
15064 @item E@var{NN}
15065 for an error
15066 @end table
15067
15068 @end table
15069
15070 @node Stop Reply Packets
15071 @section Stop Reply Packets
15072 @cindex stop reply packets
15073
15074 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15075 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15076 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15077 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15078 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15079 conventions is used.
15080
15081 @table @samp
15082
15083 @item S@var{AA}
15084 @var{AA} is the signal number
15085
15086 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
15087 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
15088
15089 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15090 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15091 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
15092 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15093 @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15094 integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15095 @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15096 to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
15097
15098 @item W@var{AA}
15099
15100 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
15101 applicable to certain targets.
15102
15103 @item X@var{AA}
15104
15105 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
15106
15107 @item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15108
15109 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15110 @code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15111 base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15112 The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15113 the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15114 is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
15115
15116 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
15117
15118 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15119 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15120 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15121
15122 @end table
15123
15124 @node General Query Packets
15125 @section General Query Packets
15126
15127 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
15128
15129 @table @r
15130
15131 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15132
15133 Return the current thread id.
15134
15135 Reply:
15136 @table @samp
15137 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
15138 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
15139 @item *
15140 Any other reply implies the old pid.
15141 @end table
15142
15143 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15144
15145 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
15146
15147 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15148 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15149 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15150 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15151 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15152 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
15153
15154 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15155
15156 Reply:
15157 @table @samp
15158 @item @code{m}@var{id}
15159 A single thread id
15160 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15161 a comma-separated list of thread ids
15162 @item @code{l}
15163 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15164 @end table
15165
15166 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15167 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15168 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
15169 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15170 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
15171
15172 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15173
15174 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15175 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15176 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15177 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15178 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15179 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15180 Mutex''.
15181
15182 Reply:
15183 @table @samp
15184 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15185 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15186 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
15187 attributes.
15188 @end table
15189
15190 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
15191
15192 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15193 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15194 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15195 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15196 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15197 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
15198
15199 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15200 (see above).
15201
15202 Reply:
15203 @table @samp
15204 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
15205 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15206 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15207 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
15208 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15209 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
15210 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
15211 @end table
15212
15213 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15214
15215 Reply:
15216 @table @samp
15217 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
15218 An error (such as memory fault)
15219 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15220 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15221 @end table
15222
15223 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
15224
15225 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15226 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15227 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15228 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
15229
15230 Reply:
15231 @table @samp
15232 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15233 @end table
15234
15235 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15236
15237 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15238 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
15239
15240 Reply:
15241 @table @samp
15242 @item *
15243 @end table
15244
15245 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
15246
15247 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15248
15249 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
15250 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15251 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
15252 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15253 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15254 interpreter may have security implications}.
15255
15256 Reply:
15257 @table @samp
15258 @item OK
15259 A command response with no output.
15260 @item @var{OUTPUT}
15261 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
15262 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
15263 Indicate a badly formed request.
15264 @item @samp{}
15265 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
15266 @end table
15267
15268 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
15269
15270 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15271 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
15272
15273 Reply:
15274 @table @samp
15275 @item @code{OK}
15276 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
15277 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15278 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15279 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15280 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15281 @end table
15282
15283 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15284
15285 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15286
15287 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15288 target has previously requested.
15289
15290 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15291 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15292 will be empty.
15293
15294 Reply:
15295 @table @samp
15296 @item @code{OK}
15297 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
15298 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15299 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15300 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15301 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15302 @end table
15303
15304 @end table
15305
15306 @node Register Packet Format
15307 @section Register Packet Format
15308
15309 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
15310 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15311 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15312 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15313 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15314 most-significant - least-significant.
15315
15316 @table @r
15317
15318 @item MIPS32
15319
15320 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
15321 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15322 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
15323
15324 @item MIPS64
15325
15326 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15327 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15328 as @code{MIPS32}.
15329
15330 @end table
15331
15332 @node Examples
15333 @section Examples
15334
15335 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15336 does not get any direct output:
15337
15338 @smallexample
15339 -> @code{R00}
15340 <- @code{+}
15341 @emph{target restarts}
15342 -> @code{?}
15343 <- @code{+}
15344 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15345 -> @code{+}
15346 @end smallexample
15347
15348 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
15349
15350 @smallexample
15351 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
15352 <- @code{+}
15353 -> @code{s}
15354 <- @code{+}
15355 @emph{time passes}
15356 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15357 -> @code{+}
15358 -> @code{g}
15359 <- @code{+}
15360 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
15361 -> @code{+}
15362 @end smallexample
15363
15364 @include gpl.texi
15365
15366 @include fdl.texi
15367
15368 @node Index
15369 @unnumbered Index
15370
15371 @printindex cp
15372
15373 @tex
15374 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15375 % meantime:
15376 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15377 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15378 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15379 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15380 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15381 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15382 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15383 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15384 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15385 \page\colophon
15386 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15387 @end tex
15388
15389 @bye
This page took 0.350131 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.